1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.90"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
511 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
513 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
517 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
523 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
525 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
529 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
531 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
541 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
546 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
550 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
552 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
555 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
559 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
564 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
573 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
575 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
576 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
583 .cindex "domainless addresses"
584 .cindex "address" "without domain"
585 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
591 .cindex "transport" "external"
592 .cindex "external transports"
593 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
600 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
605 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609 a number of common scanners are provided.
613 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
621 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
630 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
634 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
641 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642 .cindex "terminology definitions"
643 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646 below) by a blank line.
648 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655 rise to further bounce messages.
657 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
662 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
667 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
671 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
672 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
673 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
680 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
682 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
688 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
689 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
690 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
694 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
701 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
702 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
705 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
711 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
717 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
732 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733 .cindex "incorporated code"
734 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
737 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
740 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
747 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752 following statements:
755 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
757 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
761 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765 restrictions applied to it).
768 .cindex "SPA authentication"
769 .cindex "Samba project"
770 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
777 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782 conditions expressed therein.
785 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
787 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
792 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
795 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
800 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803 details, please contact
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
813 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
816 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
819 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
830 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
833 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
839 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
844 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850 software without specific, written prior permission.
852 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
862 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1373 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1379 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1383 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1386 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387 of domains that it defines.
1389 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1400 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1403 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407 remaining preconditions.
1409 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413 could lead to confusion.
1415 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416 set of addresses that it defines.
1418 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419 specified files is tested.
1421 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1428 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1438 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1443 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1452 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1460 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464 processed entirely independently of each other.
1466 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1476 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483 addresses to the same domain.
1485 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1494 .cindex "queue runner"
1495 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1505 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1512 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515 messages to other addresses.
1517 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1522 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1530 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533 .cindex "queue runner"
1534 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541 passed its retry time.
1542 You can run several queue runners at once.
1544 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1553 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1564 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1568 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1577 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1589 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1594 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1605 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1621 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1624 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1630 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1633 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1640 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641 following subdirectories are created:
1644 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1653 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655 that may be useful to some sites.
1658 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1665 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669 overridden if necessary.
1670 .cindex compiler requirements
1671 .cindex compiler version
1672 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1675 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1676 .cindex "PCRE library"
1677 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1678 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1679 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1680 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1681 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1682 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1683 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1684 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1685 If your operating system has no
1686 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1687 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1688 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1690 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1691 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1692 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1693 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1694 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1695 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1696 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1698 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1699 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1700 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1701 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1702 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1703 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1704 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1705 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1707 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1708 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1709 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1710 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1711 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1712 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1713 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1714 Berkeley DB library.
1716 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1717 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1721 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1722 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1724 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1725 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1726 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1727 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1728 file name is used unmodified.
1730 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1731 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1732 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1733 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1735 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1736 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1737 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1739 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1740 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1741 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1742 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1743 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1744 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1746 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1747 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1748 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1749 operates on a single file.
1753 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1754 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1755 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1756 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1757 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1761 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1762 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1764 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1765 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1766 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1767 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1768 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1769 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1771 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1772 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1773 in one of these lines:
1778 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1779 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1780 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1781 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1784 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1785 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1787 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1788 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1792 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1793 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1794 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1795 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1796 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1797 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1798 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1799 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1800 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1801 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1802 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1803 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1805 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1806 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1807 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1808 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1809 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1810 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1812 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1813 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1814 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1815 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1816 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1817 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1820 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1821 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1822 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1823 facilities, you need to set
1825 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1827 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1828 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1831 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1832 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1833 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1834 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1835 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1836 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1837 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1839 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1840 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1841 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1842 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1843 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1848 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1849 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1851 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1852 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1853 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1854 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1855 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1856 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1857 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1859 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1860 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1861 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1862 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1863 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1867 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1871 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1872 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1873 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1874 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1875 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1876 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1877 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1878 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1879 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1880 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1883 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1884 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1887 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1890 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1892 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1893 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1899 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1900 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1903 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1905 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1906 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1910 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1912 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1913 library and include files. For example:
1917 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1920 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1921 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1925 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1928 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1929 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1930 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1935 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1937 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1938 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1939 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1940 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1941 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1942 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1943 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1944 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1945 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1946 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1947 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1948 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1951 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1952 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1953 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1955 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1956 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1958 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1960 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1961 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1962 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1963 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1964 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1965 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1969 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1970 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1971 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1972 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1973 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1974 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1977 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1978 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1979 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1980 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1981 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1983 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1988 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1989 .cindex "lookup modules"
1990 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1991 .cindex ".so building"
1992 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1993 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1995 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1996 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1998 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2000 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2001 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2002 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2003 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2004 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2005 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2007 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2008 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2009 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2018 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2019 .cindex "build directory"
2020 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2021 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2022 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2023 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2024 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2025 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2026 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2028 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2029 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2030 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2031 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2032 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2033 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2034 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2035 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2037 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2038 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2039 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2043 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2044 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2045 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2046 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2047 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2048 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2049 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2053 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2054 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2055 given in addition to the short output.
2059 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2060 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2061 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2062 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2063 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2064 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2065 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2068 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2069 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2071 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2072 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2073 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2074 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2076 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2077 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2078 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2079 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2080 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2081 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2082 and are often not needed.
2084 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2085 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2086 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2087 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2088 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2089 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2090 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2091 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2092 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2095 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2096 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2097 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2098 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2102 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2103 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2104 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2105 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2106 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2107 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2108 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2109 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2110 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2111 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2112 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2113 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2114 containing the lines
2119 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2120 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2122 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2123 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2124 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2127 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2128 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2129 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2130 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2131 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2132 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2133 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2134 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2135 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2136 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2142 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2143 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2144 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2145 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2146 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2147 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2148 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2149 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2152 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2153 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2154 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2155 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2156 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2157 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2158 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2159 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2160 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2161 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2162 syntax. For instance:
2165 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2167 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2168 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2169 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2172 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2173 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2174 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2178 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2179 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2181 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2182 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2183 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2184 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2185 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2186 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2189 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2190 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2192 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2193 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2199 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2200 definition of all three of these variables into your
2201 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2204 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2205 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2206 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2207 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2209 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2210 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2211 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2212 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2213 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2216 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2217 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2218 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2219 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2220 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2223 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2225 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2226 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2227 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2228 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2229 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2230 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2234 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2235 .cindex "building Eximon"
2236 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2237 where the files that are involved are
2239 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2240 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2241 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2242 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2243 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2244 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2246 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2247 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2250 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2251 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2252 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2256 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2257 .cindex "installing Exim"
2258 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2259 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2260 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2261 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2262 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2263 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2264 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2265 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2266 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2267 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2268 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2269 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2271 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2272 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2273 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2274 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2275 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2276 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2277 alternative files, no default is installed.
2279 .cindex "system aliases file"
2280 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2281 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2282 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2283 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2284 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2285 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2286 and outputs a comment to the user.
2288 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2289 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2290 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2291 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2292 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2294 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2295 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2296 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2297 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2298 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2301 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2302 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2305 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2307 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2308 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2309 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2310 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2311 but this usage is deprecated.
2313 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2314 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2315 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2316 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2317 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2318 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2320 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2321 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2322 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2323 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2324 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2325 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2326 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2329 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2330 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2333 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2335 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2336 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2337 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2338 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2341 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2344 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2347 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2348 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2350 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2354 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2356 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2358 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2359 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2360 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2362 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2367 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2369 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2370 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2371 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2374 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2375 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2376 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2380 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2381 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2382 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2383 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2384 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2390 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2391 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2392 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2393 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2394 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2398 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2399 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2400 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2401 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2402 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2405 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2407 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2409 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2411 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2412 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2413 user agent. For example:
2415 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2416 From: user@your.domain.example
2417 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2418 Subject: Testing Exim
2420 This is a test message.
2423 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2424 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2425 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2427 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2428 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2429 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2430 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2431 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2432 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2434 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2436 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2437 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2438 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2439 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2440 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2442 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2443 .cindex "lock files"
2444 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2445 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2446 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2447 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2448 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2449 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2450 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2451 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2452 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2453 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2454 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2455 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2457 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2458 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2459 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2460 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2461 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2464 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2465 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2466 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2467 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2471 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2472 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2473 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2474 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2475 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2476 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2477 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2478 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2479 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2480 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2481 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2482 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2483 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2485 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2486 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2487 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2488 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2489 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2490 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2493 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2494 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2495 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2496 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2498 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2499 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2500 favourite user agent.
2502 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2503 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2504 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2505 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2506 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2507 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2511 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2512 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2513 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2514 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2515 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2516 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2517 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2518 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2524 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2525 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2526 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2528 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2530 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2531 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2532 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2533 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2534 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2536 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2538 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2540 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2541 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2542 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2550 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2551 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2552 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2553 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2554 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2555 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2556 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2557 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2558 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2561 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2563 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2564 were present before any other options.
2565 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2567 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2568 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2569 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2573 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2574 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2579 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2580 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2583 .cindex "queue runner"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2585 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2586 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2588 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2589 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2590 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2592 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2593 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2594 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2595 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2598 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2599 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2600 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2601 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2602 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2603 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2606 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2607 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2608 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2609 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2610 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2611 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2613 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2614 .cindex "envelope sender"
2615 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2616 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2617 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2618 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2619 users to set envelope senders.
2621 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2622 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2623 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2624 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2625 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2626 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2627 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2629 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2630 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2631 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2632 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2633 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2634 that are available to trusted users.
2636 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2637 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2638 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2639 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2640 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2642 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2643 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2644 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2645 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2647 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2648 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2649 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2650 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2652 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2653 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2658 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2659 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2660 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2667 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2668 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2669 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2670 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2671 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2672 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2673 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2676 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2677 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2678 . creates a man page for the options.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2682 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2689 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2690 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2691 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2692 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2695 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2696 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2697 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2700 .vitem &%--version%&
2701 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2702 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2709 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2712 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2714 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2715 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2716 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2717 clean; it ignores this option.
2722 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2723 .cindex "queue runner"
2724 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2725 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2726 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2728 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2729 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2730 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2731 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2733 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2734 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2735 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2736 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2738 When a listening daemon
2739 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2740 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2741 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2742 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2743 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2744 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2747 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2748 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2749 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2753 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2754 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2755 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2756 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2757 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2758 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2759 because these are reread each time they are used.
2763 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2764 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2768 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2769 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2770 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2771 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2772 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2773 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2775 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2776 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2777 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2778 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2779 test data. A line history is supported.
2781 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2782 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2783 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2784 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2785 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2786 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2787 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2789 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2790 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2791 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2792 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2794 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2795 defined and macros will be expanded.
2796 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2797 available to admin users.
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3053 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3054 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3055 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3056 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3057 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3058 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3060 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3061 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3062 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3063 This option requires admin privileges.
3065 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3066 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3067 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3071 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3072 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3073 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3074 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3075 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3076 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3077 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3079 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3080 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3081 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3082 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3083 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3085 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3086 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3087 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3088 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3093 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3094 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3095 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3096 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3097 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3098 arguments, for example:
3100 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3102 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3103 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3104 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3105 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3106 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3107 users, the output is as in this example:
3109 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3111 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3112 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3114 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3115 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3116 backward compatibility.)
3117 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3118 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3120 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3121 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3122 name will not be output.
3124 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3125 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3126 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3127 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3128 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3129 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3130 written directly into the spool directory.
3132 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3134 exim -bP +local_domains
3136 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3137 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3139 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3141 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3142 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3143 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3144 that driver are output. For example:
3146 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3148 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3149 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3150 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3151 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3152 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3155 .cindex "environment"
3156 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3157 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3160 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3161 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3162 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3163 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3164 The output format is one item per line.
3166 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3167 the exit status will be nonzero.
3172 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3173 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3174 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3175 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3176 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3177 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3178 to allow any user to see the queue.
3180 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3182 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3183 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3186 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3187 .cindex "size" "of message"
3188 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3189 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3190 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3191 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3192 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3193 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3194 before the sender address.
3196 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3197 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3198 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3200 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3201 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3202 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3203 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3204 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3210 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3211 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3212 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3218 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3219 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3220 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3221 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3226 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3227 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3228 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3229 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3233 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3237 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3242 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3243 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3244 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3245 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3250 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3251 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3252 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3253 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3254 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3256 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3257 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3259 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3260 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3261 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3262 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3263 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3264 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3265 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3266 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3267 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3269 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3270 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3275 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3276 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3277 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3278 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3279 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3280 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3281 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3285 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3286 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3287 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3288 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3289 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3290 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3291 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3292 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3293 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3295 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3296 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3297 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3299 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3300 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3301 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3302 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3304 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3305 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3306 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3308 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3309 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3310 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3311 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3312 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3314 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3315 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3319 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3320 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3321 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3322 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3323 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3324 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3325 messages to the MTA.
3328 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3329 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3330 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3331 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3332 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3333 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3334 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3338 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3339 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3340 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3341 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3342 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3343 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3344 the listening daemon.
3348 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3349 .cindex "address" "testing"
3350 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3351 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3352 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3353 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3354 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3356 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3357 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3359 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3360 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3363 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3364 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3365 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3366 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3367 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3370 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3371 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3372 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3373 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3375 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3376 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3377 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3378 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3381 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3382 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3384 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3385 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3386 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3387 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3388 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3389 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3394 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3395 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3396 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3397 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3398 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3399 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3401 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3402 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3403 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3404 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3405 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3406 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3407 dynamic testing facilities.
3411 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3412 .cindex "address" "verification"
3413 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3414 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3415 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3416 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3417 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3418 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3420 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3421 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3422 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3424 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3425 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3427 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3428 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3431 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3432 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3433 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3434 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3435 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3437 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3438 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3439 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3440 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3441 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3442 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3445 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3446 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3447 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3450 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3451 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3452 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3453 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3455 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3456 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3457 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3458 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3462 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3463 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3470 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3471 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3472 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3473 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3475 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3476 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3477 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3478 each port only when the first connection is received.
3480 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3481 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3483 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3485 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3486 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3487 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3488 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3489 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3490 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3491 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3492 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3493 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3495 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3496 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3497 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3498 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3499 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3500 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3501 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3502 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3503 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3505 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3506 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3507 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3508 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3509 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3510 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3511 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3513 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3514 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3515 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3516 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3517 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3518 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3519 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3521 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3522 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3523 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3526 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3527 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3528 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3529 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3530 specified by this option.
3533 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3535 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3536 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3537 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3538 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3539 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3540 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3542 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3543 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3544 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3545 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3546 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3547 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3548 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3550 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3551 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3552 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3558 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3559 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3562 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3564 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3565 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3568 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3570 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3571 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3572 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3573 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3574 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3575 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3576 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3579 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3580 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3581 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3582 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3583 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3584 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3585 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3588 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3589 &`auth `& authenticators
3590 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3591 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3592 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3593 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3594 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3595 &`filter `& filter handling
3596 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3597 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3598 &`ident `& ident lookup
3599 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3600 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3601 &`load `& system load checks
3602 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3603 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3604 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3605 &`memory `& memory handling
3606 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3607 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3608 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3609 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3610 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3611 &`retry `& retry handling
3612 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3613 &`route `& address routing
3614 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3616 &`transport `& transports
3617 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3618 &`verify `& address verification logic
3619 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3621 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3622 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3623 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3624 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3625 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3626 turn everything off.
3628 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3629 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3630 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3631 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3632 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3635 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3636 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3637 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3638 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3639 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3642 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3643 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3646 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3647 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3649 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3651 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3652 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3653 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3654 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3657 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3658 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3659 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3660 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3664 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3665 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3666 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3667 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3668 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3669 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3670 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3671 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3674 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3675 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3676 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3677 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3678 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3680 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3682 .cindex "sender" "name"
3683 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3684 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3685 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3686 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3687 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3688 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3690 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3692 .cindex "sender" "address"
3693 .cindex "address" "sender"
3694 .cindex "trusted users"
3695 .cindex "envelope sender"
3696 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3697 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3698 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3699 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3702 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3703 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3704 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3705 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3708 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3709 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3710 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3711 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3712 examples of shell commands:
3714 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3715 exim -f "" user@domain
3717 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3718 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3721 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3722 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3723 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3724 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3727 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3728 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3729 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3730 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3731 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3732 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3736 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3737 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3739 control = suppress_local_fixups
3741 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3742 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3745 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3748 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3750 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3751 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3752 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3757 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3758 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3759 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3760 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3761 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3762 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3764 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3766 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3767 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3768 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3769 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3770 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3771 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3773 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3775 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3777 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3778 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3779 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3780 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3781 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3782 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3783 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3786 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3787 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3788 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3789 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3790 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3791 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3793 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3794 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3795 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3796 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3798 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3800 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3801 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3802 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3803 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3804 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3805 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3806 can be used only by an admin user.
3808 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3809 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3811 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3812 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3813 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3814 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3815 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3816 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3817 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3818 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3824 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3828 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3829 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3830 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3832 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3834 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3836 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3840 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3841 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3842 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3846 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3847 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3848 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3850 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3852 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3853 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3854 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3855 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3856 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3857 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3863 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3868 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3869 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3870 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3872 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3874 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3875 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3876 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3877 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3879 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3881 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3882 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3883 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3884 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3885 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3886 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3887 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3888 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3889 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3890 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3891 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3892 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3893 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3895 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3897 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3898 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3899 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3900 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3901 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3902 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3903 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3904 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3906 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3908 .cindex "freezing messages"
3909 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3910 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3911 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3912 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3913 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3914 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3917 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3919 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3920 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3921 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3922 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3923 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3924 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3925 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3926 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3929 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3931 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3932 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3933 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3934 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3935 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3937 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3939 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3940 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3941 .cindex "removing recipients"
3942 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3943 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3944 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3945 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3946 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3947 can be used only by an admin user.
3949 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3951 .cindex "removing messages"
3952 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3953 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3954 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3955 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3956 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3957 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3958 placed on the queue.
3960 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3963 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3964 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3965 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3966 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3967 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3968 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3969 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3970 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3972 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3974 .cindex "thawing messages"
3975 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3976 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3977 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3978 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3979 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3980 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3983 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3985 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3986 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3987 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3988 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3990 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3992 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3993 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3994 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3995 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3996 only by an admin user.
3998 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4000 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4001 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4002 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4003 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4004 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4006 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4008 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4009 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4010 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4011 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4015 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4016 treats it that way too.
4020 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4021 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4022 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4023 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4024 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4025 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4026 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4029 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4030 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4031 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4032 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4033 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4034 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4035 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4040 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4041 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4042 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4043 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4045 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4047 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4050 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4052 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4053 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4054 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4057 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4059 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4060 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4061 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4062 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4063 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4064 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4068 .cindex "background delivery"
4069 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4070 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4071 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4072 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4073 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4074 processes to finish.
4076 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4077 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4078 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4079 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4081 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4082 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4083 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4084 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4088 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4089 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4090 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4091 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4092 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4093 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4095 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4096 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4099 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4100 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4102 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4103 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4104 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4105 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4110 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4115 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4116 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4117 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4118 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4119 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4120 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4121 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4122 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4123 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4124 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4129 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4130 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4131 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4132 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4133 configuration file is in effect.
4135 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4136 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4137 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4138 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4139 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4140 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4141 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4142 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4143 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4148 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4149 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4150 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4153 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4155 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4156 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4157 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4158 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4162 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4163 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4164 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4165 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4166 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4170 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4171 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4172 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4173 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4174 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4178 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4179 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4184 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4185 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4190 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4191 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4192 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4193 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4194 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4195 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4198 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4199 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4201 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4203 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4204 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4205 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4206 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4207 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4208 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4210 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4211 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4213 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4215 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4216 followed by a colon and the port number:
4218 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4220 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4221 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4222 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4223 whichever one is last.
4225 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4227 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4228 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4229 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4230 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4231 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4232 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4234 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4236 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4238 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4239 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4240 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4241 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4243 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4245 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4246 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4247 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4248 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4249 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4250 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4251 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4252 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4254 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4256 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4257 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4258 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4259 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4260 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4262 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4264 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4265 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4266 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4267 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4268 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4269 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4270 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4272 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4273 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4274 is sending the bounce.
4276 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4278 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4279 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4280 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4281 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4282 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4283 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4284 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4285 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4286 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4287 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4289 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4291 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4292 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4293 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4294 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4295 uses the name it is given.
4297 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4299 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4300 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4301 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4302 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4303 used, when there is no default.
4307 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4308 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4309 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4310 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4314 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4315 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4316 whatever that means.
4318 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4320 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4321 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4322 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4323 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4324 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4325 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4326 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4328 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4330 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4331 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4332 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4333 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4334 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4336 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4338 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4339 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4340 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4341 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4342 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4343 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4347 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4349 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4351 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4352 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4353 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4354 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4355 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4356 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4357 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4358 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4362 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4363 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4364 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4365 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4370 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4371 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4372 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4373 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4376 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4378 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4380 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4382 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4383 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4384 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4385 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4386 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4387 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4391 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4392 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4393 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4394 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4395 and &%-S%& options).
4397 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4398 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4399 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4400 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4401 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4402 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4403 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4406 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4407 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4408 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4409 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4410 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4413 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4414 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4415 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4416 this to be repeated periodically.
4418 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4419 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4420 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4421 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4423 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4424 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4425 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4427 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4428 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4429 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4430 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4434 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4435 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4436 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4437 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4438 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4439 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4442 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4443 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4444 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4445 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4446 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4447 delivered down a single SMTP
4448 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4449 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4450 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4451 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4452 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4455 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4457 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4458 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4459 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4460 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4461 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4463 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4465 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4466 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4467 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4468 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4469 their retry times are tried.
4471 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4473 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4474 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4477 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4479 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4480 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4481 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4484 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4487 .cindex "named queues"
4488 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4489 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4490 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4491 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4492 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4493 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4495 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4496 will specify a queue to operate on.
4499 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4501 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4504 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4505 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4506 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4507 starting message id. For example:
4509 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4511 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4512 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4513 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4515 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4517 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4518 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4519 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4520 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4521 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4522 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4524 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4525 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4526 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4527 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4528 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4529 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4530 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4531 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4532 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4534 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4536 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4537 process every 30 minutes.
4539 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4540 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4542 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4544 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4547 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4549 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4551 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4553 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4554 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4555 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4556 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4557 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4558 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4559 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4561 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4562 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4563 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4564 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4565 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4566 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4568 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4569 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4571 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4573 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4574 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4575 applied to each queue run.
4577 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4578 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4579 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4580 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4581 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4582 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4583 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4584 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4585 address will be skipped.
4587 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4588 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4589 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4592 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4593 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4594 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4595 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4596 an arbitrary command instead.
4600 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4602 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4604 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4605 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4606 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4607 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4608 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4609 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4611 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4613 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4614 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4615 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4619 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4620 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4621 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4622 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4623 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4624 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4625 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4626 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4627 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4629 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4630 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4631 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4632 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4633 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4634 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4635 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4636 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4637 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4638 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4639 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4641 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4642 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4643 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4644 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4645 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4646 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4648 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4649 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4650 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4651 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4652 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4653 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4654 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4655 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4656 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4660 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4661 compatibility with Sendmail.
4663 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4664 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4665 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4666 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4667 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4668 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4669 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4670 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4675 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4676 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4677 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4678 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4679 set. Exim ignores this option.
4683 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4684 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4685 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4686 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4687 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4688 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4693 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4694 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4695 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4698 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4700 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4701 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4703 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4705 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4706 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4707 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4716 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4717 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4718 . creates a man page for the options.
4719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4722 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4733 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4734 "The runtime configuration file"
4736 .cindex "run time configuration"
4737 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4738 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4739 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4740 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4741 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4742 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4743 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4744 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4747 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4748 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4749 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4750 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4751 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4752 actually alter the string.
4754 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4755 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4756 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4757 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4758 existing file in the list.
4761 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4762 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4763 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4764 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4765 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4766 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4767 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4768 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4769 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4770 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4772 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4773 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4774 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4775 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4776 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4778 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4779 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4780 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4781 compromise the Exim user account.
4783 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4784 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4785 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4786 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4787 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4788 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4793 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4794 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4795 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4796 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4797 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4798 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4799 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4800 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4801 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4802 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4803 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4805 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4806 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4807 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4808 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4809 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4810 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4811 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4812 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4813 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4816 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4817 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4818 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4819 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4820 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4822 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4823 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4824 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4825 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4826 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4827 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4829 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4830 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4831 necessarily be discarded.
4832 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4833 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4834 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4835 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4836 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4837 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4839 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4840 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4841 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4842 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4843 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4844 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4845 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4847 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4848 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4849 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4853 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4854 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4855 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4856 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4857 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4858 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4859 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4860 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4863 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4866 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4867 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4868 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4870 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4871 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4872 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4874 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4875 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4876 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4878 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4879 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4880 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4881 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4884 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4885 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4886 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4888 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4889 want to use this feature, you must set
4891 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4893 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4894 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4897 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4898 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4899 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4900 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4902 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4903 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4904 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4905 and does not introduce a comment.
4907 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4908 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4909 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4910 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4911 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4913 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4914 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4915 change settings as required.
4917 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4918 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4919 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4920 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4921 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4926 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4927 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4928 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4929 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4930 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4931 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4934 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4935 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4937 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4938 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4939 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4940 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4941 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4944 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4945 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4946 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4947 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4949 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4950 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4953 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4956 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4957 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4962 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4963 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4964 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4965 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4966 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4967 definition, and must be of the form
4969 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4971 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4972 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4973 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4974 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4975 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4977 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4978 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4979 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4981 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4982 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4983 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4984 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4985 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4986 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4987 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4990 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4991 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4993 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4994 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4995 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4996 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4997 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4998 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5001 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5002 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5003 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5008 MAC == updated value
5010 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5011 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5012 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5013 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5017 MAC == MAC and something added
5019 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5020 from a number of other files.
5022 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5023 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5024 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5025 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5026 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5031 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5032 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5033 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5034 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5036 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5037 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5039 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5041 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5043 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5044 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5045 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5048 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5049 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5050 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5051 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5052 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5055 The following classes of macros are defined:
5057 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5058 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5059 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5060 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5061 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5062 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5063 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5064 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5065 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5066 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5067 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5070 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5073 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5074 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5075 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5076 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5077 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5078 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5079 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5081 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5082 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5083 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5087 message_size_limit = 50M
5089 message_size_limit = 100M
5092 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5093 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5094 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5095 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5096 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5098 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5099 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5100 in this line"& will always be true.
5102 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5103 to clarify complicated nestings.
5107 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5108 .cindex "common option syntax"
5109 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5110 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5111 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5112 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5113 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5114 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5115 space) and then the value. For example:
5117 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5119 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5120 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5121 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5122 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5123 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5124 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5125 word &"hide"&. For example:
5127 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5129 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5131 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5133 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5134 all instances of the same driver.
5136 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5137 that are found in option settings.
5140 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5141 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5142 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5143 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5144 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5145 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5146 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5147 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5148 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5149 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5150 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5151 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5156 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5161 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5166 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5167 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5168 .cindex "format" "integer"
5169 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5170 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5171 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5172 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5175 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5176 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5177 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5179 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5180 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5181 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5185 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5186 .cindex "integer format"
5187 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5188 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5189 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5190 Such options are always output in octal.
5193 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5194 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5195 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5196 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5197 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5201 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5202 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5203 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5204 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5205 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5215 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5216 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5217 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5221 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5222 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5223 .cindex "format" "string"
5224 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5225 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5226 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5227 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5228 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5229 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5230 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5231 therefore equivalent:
5233 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5234 trusted_users = uucp:\
5235 # This comment line is ignored
5238 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5239 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5240 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5241 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5242 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5245 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5246 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5247 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5249 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5250 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5254 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5255 character, that character replaces the pair.
5257 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5258 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5259 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5260 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5261 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5262 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5265 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5266 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5267 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5268 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5269 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5270 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5271 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5272 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5273 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5274 within a quoted configuration string.
5277 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5278 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5279 .cindex "format" "user name"
5280 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5281 .cindex "format" "group name"
5282 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5283 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5284 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5285 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5288 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5289 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5290 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5291 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5292 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5293 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5294 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5295 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5296 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5297 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5298 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5300 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5301 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5302 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5303 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5304 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5305 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5308 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5310 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5312 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5313 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5314 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5315 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5317 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5318 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5319 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5320 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5321 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5322 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5323 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5324 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5326 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5328 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5329 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5330 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5332 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5333 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5334 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5335 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5336 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5337 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5338 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5339 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5340 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5342 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5344 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5345 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5346 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5347 the value in quotes. For example:
5349 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5351 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5352 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5353 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5354 enclosing an empty list item.
5358 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5359 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5360 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5361 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5363 senders = user@domain :
5365 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5366 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5367 items, the second of which is empty:
5369 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5371 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5372 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5373 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5374 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5378 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5379 is at the end of the list.
5384 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5385 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5386 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5387 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5388 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5389 a sequence of lines like this:
5391 <&'instance name'&>:
5396 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5397 followed by three options settings:
5402 transport = local_delivery
5404 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5405 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5406 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5407 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5408 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5409 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5411 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5412 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5414 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5415 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5416 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5417 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5418 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5421 .cindex "generic options"
5422 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5423 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5424 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5425 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5426 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5427 .cindex "private options"
5428 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5429 they all have default values.
5431 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5432 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5433 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5435 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5436 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5437 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5438 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5439 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5440 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5441 configuration lines:
5446 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5447 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5448 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5449 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5455 command_timeout = 10s
5457 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5458 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5461 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5462 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5463 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5474 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5475 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5476 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5477 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5478 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5479 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5480 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5481 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5482 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5483 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5484 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5488 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5489 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5490 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5493 # primary_hostname =
5495 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5496 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5497 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5498 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5500 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5502 domainlist local_domains = @
5503 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5504 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5506 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5507 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5508 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5509 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5511 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5512 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5515 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5516 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5517 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5518 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5519 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5520 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5522 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5523 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5524 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5525 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5526 domain is permitted.
5528 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5529 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5530 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5531 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5532 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5533 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5535 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5536 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5537 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5539 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5541 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5542 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5544 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5545 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5546 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5547 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5548 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5549 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5550 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5551 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5552 contents of a message to be checked.
5554 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5556 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5557 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5559 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5560 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5561 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5562 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5564 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5566 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5567 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5568 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5570 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5571 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5572 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5573 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5574 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5575 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5576 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5578 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5580 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5581 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5583 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5584 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5585 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5586 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5587 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5588 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5589 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5590 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5591 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5592 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5593 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5594 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5595 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5596 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5597 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5598 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5600 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5601 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5602 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5603 which should be used in preference to 587.
5604 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5606 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5608 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5611 # qualify_recipient =
5613 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5614 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5615 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5616 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5617 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5618 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5620 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5621 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5622 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5623 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5625 # allow_domain_literals
5627 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5628 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5629 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5630 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5631 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5632 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5634 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5638 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5639 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5640 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5641 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5642 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5643 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5644 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5645 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5647 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5648 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5653 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5654 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5655 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5656 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5657 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5658 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5661 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5662 1413 (hence their names):
5665 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5667 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5668 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5669 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5670 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5671 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5672 information, you can change this.
5674 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5675 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5680 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5681 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5682 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5683 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5685 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5686 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5688 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5689 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5691 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5694 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5695 +tls_certificate_verified
5698 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5700 # percent_hack_domains =
5702 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5703 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5704 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5706 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5707 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5708 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5709 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5710 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5711 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5712 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5713 always bounce messages.
5715 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5716 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5718 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5719 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5720 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5721 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5722 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5724 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5725 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5726 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5727 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5728 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5731 # split_spool_directory = true
5734 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5735 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5736 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5737 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5738 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5739 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5740 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5742 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5745 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5746 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5747 that are not 8-bit clean.
5749 # accept_8bitmime = false
5752 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5753 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5754 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5755 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5756 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5757 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5759 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5760 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5764 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5765 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5766 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5767 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5768 It starts with the line
5772 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5773 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5774 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5776 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5777 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5778 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5779 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5780 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5781 result of the ACL processing.
5785 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5790 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5791 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5792 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5793 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5794 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5795 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5797 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5798 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5799 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5802 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5803 domains = +local_domains
5804 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5806 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5807 domains = !+local_domains
5808 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5810 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5811 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5812 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5813 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5814 in Internet mail addresses.
5816 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5817 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5818 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5819 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5820 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5821 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5822 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5823 policy of being as safe as possible.
5825 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5826 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5827 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5828 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5829 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5830 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5832 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5833 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5834 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5835 have to modify this rule.
5837 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5838 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5839 common convention of local parts constructed as
5840 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5841 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5842 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5843 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5844 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5845 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5847 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5848 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5849 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5850 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5851 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5852 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5853 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5855 accept local_parts = postmaster
5856 domains = +local_domains
5858 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5859 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5860 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5861 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5862 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5864 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5865 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5866 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5868 require verify = sender
5870 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5871 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5872 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5873 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5874 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5875 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5876 discusses the details of address verification.
5878 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5879 control = submission
5881 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5882 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5883 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5884 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5885 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5886 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5887 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5888 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5889 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5891 accept authenticated = *
5892 control = submission
5894 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5895 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5896 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5897 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5898 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5899 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5901 require message = relay not permitted
5902 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5904 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5905 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5907 require verify = recipient
5909 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5910 fails, the address is rejected.
5912 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5913 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5915 # dnslists = black.list.example
5917 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5918 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5919 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5920 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5922 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5923 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5924 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5927 # require verify = csa
5929 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5930 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5935 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5936 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5940 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5941 of this ACL are commented out:
5944 # message = This message contains a virus \
5947 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5948 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5949 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5950 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5952 # warn spam = nobody
5953 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5954 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5955 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5956 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5958 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5959 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5960 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5961 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5962 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5963 whatever the spam score.
5967 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5970 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5971 .cindex "default" "routers"
5972 .cindex "routers" "default"
5973 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5978 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5979 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5980 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5981 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5982 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5985 # driver = ipliteral
5986 # domains = !+local_domains
5987 # transport = remote_smtp
5989 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5990 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5991 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5992 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5993 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5997 domains = ! +local_domains
5998 transport = remote_smtp
5999 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6002 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6003 domains. This is specified by the line
6005 domains = ! +local_domains
6007 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6008 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6009 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6010 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6011 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6012 passed on to the following routers.
6014 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6015 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6016 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6017 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6018 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6020 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6021 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6022 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6023 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6024 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6025 the address fails and is bounced.
6027 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6028 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6029 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6030 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6031 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6032 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6033 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6040 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6042 file_transport = address_file
6043 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6045 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6046 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6047 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6048 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6049 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6052 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6053 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6054 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6055 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6060 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6061 # local_part_suffix_optional
6062 file = $home/.forward
6067 file_transport = address_file
6068 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6069 reply_transport = address_reply
6071 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6072 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6073 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6074 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6075 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6078 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6079 # local_part_suffix_optional
6081 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6082 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6083 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6084 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6085 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6086 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6087 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6089 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6090 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6091 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6092 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6094 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6095 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6096 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6097 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6098 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6099 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6100 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6102 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6103 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6104 There are two reasons for doing this:
6107 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6108 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6111 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6112 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6113 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6114 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6118 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6119 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6120 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6121 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6123 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6124 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6125 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6127 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6129 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6135 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6136 # local_part_suffix_optional
6137 transport = local_delivery
6139 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6140 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6141 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6142 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6143 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6146 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6147 .cindex "default" "transports"
6148 .cindex "transports" "default"
6149 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6150 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6151 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6155 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6161 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6162 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6163 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6164 It is negotiated between client and server
6165 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6166 All other options are defaulted.
6170 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6177 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6178 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6179 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6180 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6181 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6182 show how this can be done.
6184 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6185 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6186 similarly-named options above.
6192 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6193 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6194 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6195 be returned to the sender.
6203 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6204 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6205 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6210 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6215 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6216 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6217 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6218 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6219 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6220 introduced by the line
6224 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6227 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6229 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6230 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6231 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6232 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6233 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6235 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6236 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6237 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6240 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6241 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6245 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6246 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6250 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6251 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6252 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6254 begin authenticators
6256 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6257 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6258 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6259 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6260 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6261 to support most MUA software.
6263 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6266 # driver = plaintext
6267 # server_set_id = $auth2
6268 # server_prompts = :
6269 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6270 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6272 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6275 # driver = plaintext
6276 # server_set_id = $auth1
6277 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6278 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6279 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6282 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6283 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6284 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6285 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6286 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6287 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6288 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6289 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6291 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6292 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6293 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6294 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6296 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6297 usercode and password are in different positions.
6298 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6300 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6307 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6309 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6311 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6312 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6313 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6314 regular expressions is discussed in
6315 online Perl manpages, in
6316 many Perl reference books, and also in
6317 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6318 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6320 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6321 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6322 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6323 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6324 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6327 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6328 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6329 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6330 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6332 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6334 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6335 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6336 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6337 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6338 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6339 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6342 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6343 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6344 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6345 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6346 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6347 match anywhere in the subject string.
6349 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6350 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6352 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6354 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6357 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6359 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6360 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6367 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6368 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6369 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6370 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6371 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6372 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6375 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6376 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6377 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6378 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6379 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6380 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6382 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6383 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6384 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6385 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6386 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6387 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6390 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6391 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6392 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6393 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6394 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6395 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6397 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6398 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6399 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6400 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6401 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6403 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6404 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6406 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6407 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6408 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6409 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6410 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6412 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6413 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6415 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6416 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6418 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6419 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6420 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6425 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6426 matches the list item.
6428 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6429 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6431 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6433 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6434 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6435 causes a second lookup to occur.
6437 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6438 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6439 lookup is permitted.
6442 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6443 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6444 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6445 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6448 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6449 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6450 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6452 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6453 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6454 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6455 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6458 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6459 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6460 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6465 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6466 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6467 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6472 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6473 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6474 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6475 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6478 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6479 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6480 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6481 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6482 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6483 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6484 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6485 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6486 be found in several places:
6488 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6489 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6490 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6492 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6493 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6494 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6495 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6497 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6498 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6499 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6500 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6501 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6502 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6503 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6505 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6506 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6507 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6508 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6509 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6510 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6511 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6513 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6514 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6516 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6517 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6518 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6519 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6520 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6521 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6522 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6524 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6525 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6526 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6528 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6529 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6530 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6531 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6532 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6533 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6534 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6535 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6536 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6537 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6539 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6540 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6541 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6542 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6543 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6544 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6545 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6546 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6547 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6549 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6550 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6551 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6552 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6553 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6554 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6555 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6557 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6558 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6559 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6560 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6562 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6563 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6564 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6565 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6566 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6568 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6569 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6570 lookup types support only literal keys.
6572 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6573 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6574 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6576 .cindex "linear search"
6577 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6578 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6579 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6580 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6581 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6582 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6583 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6584 in the file is used.
6586 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6587 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6588 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6589 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6590 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6595 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6596 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6597 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6598 wildcarding of any kind.
6600 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6601 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6602 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6603 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6604 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6605 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6606 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6607 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6608 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6611 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6612 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6613 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6614 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6615 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6616 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6617 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6618 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6621 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6623 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6624 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6625 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6626 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6627 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6628 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6629 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6631 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6632 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6633 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6634 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6636 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6637 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6640 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6642 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6643 *fish data for anythingfish
6646 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6647 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6649 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6651 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6652 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6653 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6655 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6657 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6658 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6659 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6661 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6664 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6665 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6666 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6667 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6668 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6670 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6671 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6672 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6673 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6674 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6677 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6678 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6679 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6682 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6684 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6687 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6688 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6689 be followed by optional colons.
6691 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6692 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6693 lookup types support only literal keys.
6697 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6698 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6699 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6700 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6701 many of them are given in later sections.
6704 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6705 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6706 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6707 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6708 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6710 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6711 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6712 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6714 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6715 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6716 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6717 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6718 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6719 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6720 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6722 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6723 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6724 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6725 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6727 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6728 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6729 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6730 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6732 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6733 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6734 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6735 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6737 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6738 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6739 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6740 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6741 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6742 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6743 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6744 password value. For example:
6746 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6749 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6750 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6751 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6752 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6755 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6756 .cindex lookup Redis
6757 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6758 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6761 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6762 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6763 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6764 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6767 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6768 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6770 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6772 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6773 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6774 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6775 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6776 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6777 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6778 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6780 require condition = \
6781 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6783 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6784 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6785 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6786 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6791 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6792 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6793 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6794 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6795 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6796 options such as a list of local domains.
6798 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6799 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6800 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6801 or may give up altogether.
6805 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6806 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6807 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6808 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6809 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6810 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6811 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6812 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6814 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6815 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6816 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6818 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6819 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6820 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6822 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6823 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6824 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6825 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6826 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6827 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6828 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6829 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6830 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6831 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6833 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6835 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6836 looks up these keys, in this order:
6842 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6843 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6844 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6845 Exim move on to try the next key.
6849 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6850 .cindex "partial matching"
6851 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6852 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6853 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6854 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6855 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6856 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6857 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6858 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6859 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6860 a key in a DBM file is
6862 *.dates.fict.example
6864 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6865 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6866 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6869 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6870 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6871 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6873 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6874 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6875 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6876 partial matching keys
6877 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6878 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6879 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6881 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6882 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6883 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6884 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6885 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6886 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6889 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6890 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6891 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6892 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6893 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6894 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6896 2250.dates.fict.example
6897 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6898 *.dates.fict.example
6901 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6904 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6905 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6906 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6907 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6908 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6909 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6911 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6913 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6914 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6915 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6916 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6918 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6920 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6921 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6923 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6924 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6925 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6928 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6930 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6931 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6933 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6934 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6935 for &"*"& on its own.
6937 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6941 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6942 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6943 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6944 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6945 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6946 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6947 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6949 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6950 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6951 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6952 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6953 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6958 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6959 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6960 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6961 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6962 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6963 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6964 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6966 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6967 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6968 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6969 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6970 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6971 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6973 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6974 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6980 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6981 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6982 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6983 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6984 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6985 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6989 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6990 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6992 [name="$local_part"]
6994 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6995 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6996 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6997 of the following form is provided:
6999 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7001 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7003 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7005 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7006 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7007 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7012 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7013 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7014 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7015 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7016 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7017 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7018 an expansion string could contain:
7020 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7022 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7023 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7024 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7025 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7027 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7028 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7029 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7031 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7032 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7033 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7034 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7035 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7037 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7039 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7040 white space is ignored.
7041 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7042 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7043 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7045 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7046 When the type is PTR,
7047 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7048 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7050 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7052 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7053 altered and nothing is added.
7055 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7056 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7057 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7058 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7059 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7060 The field separator can be modified as above.
7062 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7063 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7064 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7065 unless a field separator is specified.
7066 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7068 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7070 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7071 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7072 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7074 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7075 white space is ignored.
7077 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7078 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7079 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7080 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7083 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7086 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7087 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7088 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7089 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7090 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7091 each followed by a comma,
7092 that may appear before the record type.
7094 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7095 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7096 a defer-option modifier.
7097 The possible keywords are
7098 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7099 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7100 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7101 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7102 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7103 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7104 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7106 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7107 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7109 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7110 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7112 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7113 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7114 The possible keywords are
7115 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7116 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7118 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7119 is not labelled as authenticated data
7120 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7121 The default is &"never"&.
7123 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7125 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7126 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7127 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7128 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7130 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7132 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7133 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7134 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7136 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7137 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7139 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7140 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7141 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7144 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7145 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7146 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7147 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7148 the pseudo-type MXH:
7150 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7152 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7155 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7156 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7157 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7158 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7159 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7160 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7161 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7162 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7164 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7165 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7167 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7168 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7169 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7171 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7172 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7173 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7174 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7175 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7178 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7179 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7180 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7181 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7182 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7183 result of a successful lookup such as:
7185 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7187 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7188 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7189 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7191 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7192 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7193 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7194 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7196 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7200 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7201 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7202 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7203 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7204 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7206 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7207 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7208 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7210 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7211 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7212 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7213 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7215 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7216 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7217 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7222 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7223 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7224 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7225 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7226 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7227 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7228 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7229 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7230 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7231 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7232 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7233 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7235 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7236 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7237 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7238 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7239 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7241 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7242 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7244 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7245 the way they handle the results of a query:
7248 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7251 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7252 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7254 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7255 from all of them are returned.
7259 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7260 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7261 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7262 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7265 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7266 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7267 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7268 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7270 data = ${lookup ldap \
7271 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7272 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7274 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7275 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7276 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7277 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7279 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7280 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7281 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7283 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7284 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7285 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7286 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7287 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7288 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7289 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7290 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7294 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7295 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7296 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7297 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7298 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7299 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7301 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7302 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7310 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7311 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7315 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7317 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7321 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7323 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7325 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7327 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7328 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7329 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7333 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7334 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7335 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7337 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7341 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7343 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7345 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7347 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7348 authentication below.
7351 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7352 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7353 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7354 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7355 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7358 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7360 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7361 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7362 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7363 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7364 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7365 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7366 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7367 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7368 failures, and timeouts.
7370 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7371 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7372 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7373 doubled. For example
7375 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7377 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7378 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7379 the local host) is used.
7381 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7382 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7383 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7384 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7387 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7388 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7389 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7390 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7392 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7394 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7395 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7397 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7399 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7400 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7401 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7402 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7403 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7404 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7405 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7408 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7409 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7410 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7413 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7416 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7420 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7421 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7425 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7426 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7427 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7428 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7429 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7430 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7431 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7432 them. The following names are recognized:
7434 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7435 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7436 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7437 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7438 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7439 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7440 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7441 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7443 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7444 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7445 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7446 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7448 .cindex LDAP timeout
7449 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7450 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7451 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7452 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7453 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7454 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7455 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7456 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7457 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7458 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7460 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7461 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7463 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7464 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7465 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7466 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7467 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7468 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7469 alternate list (colon-separated).
7471 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7472 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7475 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7476 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7479 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7480 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7481 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7482 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7484 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7485 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7486 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7488 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7489 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7490 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7491 quoting has two advantages:
7494 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7495 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7497 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7500 For example, a setting such as
7502 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7504 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7506 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7507 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7508 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7509 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7513 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7514 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7519 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7520 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7521 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7522 as a sequence of values, for example
7524 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7526 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7527 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7528 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7529 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7530 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7533 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7534 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7535 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7536 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7538 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7539 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7540 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7541 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7542 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7543 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7544 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7545 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7546 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7548 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7549 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7550 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7551 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7552 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7555 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7558 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7561 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7562 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7564 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7565 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7567 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7568 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7571 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7572 results of LDAP lookups.
7573 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7574 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7575 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7576 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7577 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7578 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7583 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7584 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7585 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7586 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7587 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7588 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7589 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7590 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7592 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7594 might return the string
7596 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7597 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7599 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7601 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7607 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7608 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7609 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7613 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7614 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7615 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7616 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7617 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7618 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7619 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7620 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7621 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7622 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7623 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7624 .cindex lookup Redis
7625 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7627 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7630 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7633 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7634 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7636 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7641 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7643 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7644 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7645 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7649 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7650 with a newline between the data for each row.
7653 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7654 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7655 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7656 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7657 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7658 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7659 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7660 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7661 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7662 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7663 .cindex lookup Redis
7664 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7665 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7666 or &%redis_servers%&
7667 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7669 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7670 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7671 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7673 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7674 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7675 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7676 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7678 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7680 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7681 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7682 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7684 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7685 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7687 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7688 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7689 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7690 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7691 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7692 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7694 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7695 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7696 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7698 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7699 host, database number, and password.
7701 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7702 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7703 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7705 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7707 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7710 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7711 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7712 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7713 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7715 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7716 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7718 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7719 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7720 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7721 done by starting the query with
7723 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7725 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7727 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7728 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7729 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7732 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7734 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7735 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7736 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7738 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7739 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7740 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7743 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7747 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7749 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7751 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7752 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7753 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7755 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7759 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7760 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7761 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7762 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7763 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7764 the default value is &"exim"&.
7765 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7767 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7768 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7770 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7771 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7773 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7776 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7777 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7779 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7780 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7781 is zero because no rows are affected.
7784 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7785 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7786 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7787 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7788 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7791 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7793 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7794 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7795 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7797 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7798 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7801 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7802 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7803 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7804 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7805 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7806 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7807 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7808 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7809 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7811 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7812 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7814 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7816 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7817 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7819 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7820 quote, which it doubles.
7822 .cindex timeout SQLite
7823 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7824 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7825 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7826 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7827 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7828 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7829 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7832 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7833 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7834 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7835 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7838 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7839 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7843 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
7844 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
7845 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
7846 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
7849 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, exim does not
7850 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
7851 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
7859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7862 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7863 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7864 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7865 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7866 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7867 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7868 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7869 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7870 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7872 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7873 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7874 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7875 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7877 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7878 support all the complexity available in
7879 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7883 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7884 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7885 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7887 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7888 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7891 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7892 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7893 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7894 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7895 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7898 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7899 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7900 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7902 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7903 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7904 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7905 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7906 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7908 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7909 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7911 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7912 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7913 senders based on the receiving domain.
7918 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7919 .cindex "list" "negation"
7920 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7921 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7922 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7923 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7924 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7925 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7927 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7928 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7929 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7930 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7931 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7933 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7935 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7936 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7937 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7939 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7941 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7942 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7943 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7945 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7946 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7951 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7952 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7953 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7954 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7955 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7956 file names are not allowed,
7957 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7958 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7962 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7963 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7965 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7966 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7967 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7969 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7973 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7974 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7975 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7976 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7978 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7979 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7981 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7983 and the file contains the lines
7988 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7989 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7993 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7994 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7995 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7996 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7997 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7998 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7999 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8000 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8002 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8003 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
8004 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8005 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8010 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8011 .cindex "named lists"
8012 .cindex "list" "named"
8013 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8014 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8015 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8016 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8017 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8018 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8019 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8021 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8023 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8024 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8025 configured with the line
8027 domains = +local_domains
8029 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8030 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8034 domains = ! +local_domains
8035 transport = remote_smtp
8038 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8039 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8040 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8041 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8043 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8044 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8046 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8048 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8049 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8050 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8052 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8053 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8054 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8056 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8057 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8059 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8060 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8061 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8063 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8065 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8066 referenced lists if you can.
8068 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8069 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8070 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8072 domains = +local_domains
8074 on several of your routers
8075 or in several ACL statements,
8076 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8077 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8078 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8079 the same each time they are referenced.
8081 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8082 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8083 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8084 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8088 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8089 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8090 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8091 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8092 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8095 ALIST = host1 : host2
8096 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8098 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8100 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8102 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8105 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8106 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8108 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8110 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8114 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8115 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8116 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8117 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8118 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8119 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8120 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8121 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8122 message. For example:
8124 domainlist special_domains = \
8125 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8127 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8128 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8129 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8130 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8131 same list each time.
8133 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8134 cache the result anyway. For example:
8136 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8138 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8139 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8143 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8144 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8145 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8146 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8147 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8150 .cindex "primary host name"
8151 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8152 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8153 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8154 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8155 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8156 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8157 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8158 differ only in their names.
8160 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8161 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8162 .cindex "domain literal"
8163 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8164 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8165 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8166 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8167 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8168 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8171 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8172 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8173 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8174 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8175 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8176 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8177 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8178 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8179 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8180 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8181 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8183 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8184 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8185 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8186 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8187 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8189 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8190 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8191 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8192 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8193 on a router). For example:
8195 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8197 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8198 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8200 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8201 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8202 contain negative items.
8204 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8205 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8206 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8208 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8209 an.other.domain : ...
8211 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8212 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8214 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8215 an.other.domain ? ...
8218 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8219 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8220 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8221 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8222 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8223 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8224 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8225 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8226 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8230 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8231 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8232 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8233 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8234 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8235 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8236 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8237 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8238 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8240 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8241 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8242 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8243 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8244 expression by expansion, of course).
8246 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8247 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8248 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8249 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8250 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8251 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8253 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8255 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8256 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8257 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8258 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8259 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8260 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8261 other statements in the same ACL.
8264 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8265 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8267 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8269 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8270 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8273 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8274 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8275 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8276 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8277 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8278 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8281 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8282 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8283 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8284 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8286 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8287 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8289 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8290 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8291 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8292 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8293 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8295 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8296 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8297 between the pattern and the domain.
8300 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8302 domainlist funny_domains = \
8305 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8306 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8307 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8308 nis;domains.byname : \
8309 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8311 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8312 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8313 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8314 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8315 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8320 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8321 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8322 .cindex "list" "host list"
8323 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8324 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8325 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8326 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8327 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8328 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8329 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8332 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8333 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8334 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8335 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8336 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8337 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8340 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8341 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8342 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8346 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8347 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8348 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8349 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8350 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8351 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8352 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8355 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8356 inspecting its IP address:
8359 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8360 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8361 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8362 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8363 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8364 with the IP address of the subject host.
8366 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8367 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8368 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8369 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8370 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8373 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8374 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8375 domain name, as just described.
8378 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8379 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8380 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8381 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8382 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8383 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8384 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8385 that can never match a client host.
8388 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8389 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8390 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8391 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8393 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8397 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8398 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8399 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8400 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8401 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8402 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8403 significant end of the address.
8405 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8406 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8407 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8408 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8412 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8413 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8416 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8418 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8419 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8421 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8422 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8425 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8427 could make use of a file containing
8432 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8433 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8434 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8436 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8439 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8445 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8446 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8447 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8448 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8449 address, the pattern takes this form:
8451 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8455 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8457 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8458 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8459 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8460 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8461 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8462 returned by the lookup is not used.
8464 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8465 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8466 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8467 patterns of this form:
8469 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8473 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8475 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8476 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8477 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8478 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8479 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8481 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8482 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8483 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8484 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8485 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8486 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8487 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8488 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8489 addresses are always used.
8491 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8492 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8493 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8496 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8497 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8498 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8499 case the IP address is used on its own.
8503 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8504 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8505 .cindex "unknown host name"
8506 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8507 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8508 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8509 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8510 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8513 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8514 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8515 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8516 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8517 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8518 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8519 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8521 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8522 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8524 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8525 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8526 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8527 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8528 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8529 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8530 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8531 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8532 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8534 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8535 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8537 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8538 .cindex "alias for host"
8539 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8540 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8543 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8544 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8545 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8546 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8547 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8550 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8551 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8552 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8553 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8554 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8555 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8556 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8561 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8562 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8563 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8564 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8565 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8567 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8569 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8570 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8571 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8578 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8579 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8580 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8581 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8582 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8583 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8585 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8586 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8588 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8589 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8590 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8591 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8592 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8593 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8594 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8595 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8596 not recognized in an indirected file).
8599 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8600 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8602 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8604 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8605 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8608 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8609 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8612 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8615 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8616 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8617 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8620 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8621 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8624 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8626 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8628 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8629 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8630 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8633 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8634 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8635 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8637 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8639 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8640 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8641 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8642 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8643 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8644 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8645 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8648 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8649 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8651 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8652 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8654 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8655 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8656 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8661 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8663 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8664 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8665 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8666 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8667 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8668 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8669 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8670 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8671 host lists such as whitelists.
8675 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8676 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8677 .cindex "unknown host name"
8678 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8679 If a pattern is of the form
8681 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8685 dbm;/host/accept/list
8687 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8688 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8691 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8692 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8693 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8694 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8695 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8696 lookup, both using the same file.
8700 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8701 If a pattern is of the form
8703 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8705 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8706 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8707 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8709 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8710 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8712 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8713 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8714 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8717 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8718 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8719 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8721 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8722 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8723 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8724 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8725 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8726 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8732 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8733 .cindex "list" "address list"
8734 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8735 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8736 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8737 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8738 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8739 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8740 using this option setting:
8744 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8745 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8746 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8747 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8749 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8752 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8754 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8755 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8756 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8757 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8758 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8759 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8760 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8762 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8763 *@+hostile_domains:\
8764 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8765 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8767 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8768 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8769 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8770 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8771 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8773 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8774 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8775 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8776 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8777 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8779 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8782 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8783 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8787 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8788 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8789 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8790 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8791 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8792 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8793 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8795 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8796 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8798 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8799 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8802 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8803 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8804 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8807 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8808 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8809 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8811 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8812 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8813 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8814 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8816 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8817 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8819 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8820 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8821 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8822 default. For example, with this lookup:
8824 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8826 the file could contains lines like this:
8828 user1@domain1.example
8831 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8834 nimrod@jaeger.example
8838 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8839 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8841 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8843 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8844 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8846 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8847 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8848 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8852 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8853 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8858 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8859 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8860 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8861 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8862 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8863 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8864 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8865 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8866 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8868 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8869 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8870 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8871 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8872 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8875 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8877 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8879 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8881 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8883 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8884 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8885 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8886 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8887 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8888 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8890 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8893 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8896 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8897 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8898 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8899 might have entries like
8901 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8902 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8905 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8906 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8907 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8908 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8910 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8911 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8912 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8915 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8916 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8917 can only return a single list of local parts.
8920 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8921 in these two examples:
8924 senders = *@+my_list
8926 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8927 example it is a named domain list.
8932 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8933 .cindex "case of local parts"
8934 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8935 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8936 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8937 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8938 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8939 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8940 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8941 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8944 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8945 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8946 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8947 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8948 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8949 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8950 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8953 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8954 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8955 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8956 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8957 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8958 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8959 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8960 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8964 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8965 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8966 .cindex "local part" "list"
8967 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8968 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8969 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8970 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8971 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8972 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8973 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8974 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8976 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8977 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8978 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8979 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8980 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8981 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8982 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8984 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8992 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8993 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8994 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8995 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8997 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8998 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8999 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9000 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9001 escape character, as described in the following section.
9003 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9004 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9005 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9006 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9007 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9012 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9013 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9014 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9015 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9016 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9017 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9018 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9019 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9021 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9022 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9023 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9024 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9026 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9028 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9029 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9034 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9035 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9036 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9037 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9038 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9039 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9040 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9043 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9044 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9045 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9048 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9049 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9050 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9052 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9053 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9054 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9055 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9056 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9057 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9058 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9061 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9062 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9063 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9066 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9067 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9068 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9069 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9071 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9073 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9074 Exim message identifier. For example:
9076 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9078 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9079 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9082 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9083 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9084 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9085 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9086 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9087 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9088 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9089 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9090 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9091 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9092 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9093 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9099 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9100 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9101 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9102 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9103 white space is significant.
9106 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9107 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9108 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9113 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9114 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9115 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9116 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9117 given, the expansion fails.
9119 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9120 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9121 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9122 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9126 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9127 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9128 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9129 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9130 string easier to understand.
9132 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9133 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9134 expansion item below.
9137 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9138 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9139 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9140 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9141 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9142 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9143 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9144 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9145 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9146 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9147 the result of the expansion.
9148 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9149 the expansion result is an empty string.
9150 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9154 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9155 .cindex authentication "results header"
9156 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9157 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9158 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9159 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9161 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9162 will ba a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9163 Methods that may be present in the result include:
9172 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9174 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9176 This is safe even if no authentication reselts are available.
9180 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9181 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9182 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9183 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9184 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9185 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9186 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9187 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9191 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9192 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9197 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9201 If the field is found,
9202 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9203 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9204 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9205 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9207 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9208 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9211 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9213 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9214 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9216 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9217 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9218 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9219 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9220 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9221 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9222 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9223 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9225 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9226 take an optional modifier of "int"
9227 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9228 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9229 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9231 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9232 newline-separated by default,
9233 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9234 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9235 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9237 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9238 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9239 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9240 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9241 if so the element tags are omitted.
9243 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9245 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9246 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9248 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9249 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9253 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9254 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9255 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9257 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9258 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9259 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9260 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9261 must have the following type:
9263 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9265 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9266 function should return one of the following values:
9268 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9269 into the expanded string that is being built.
9271 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9272 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9274 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9275 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9277 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9279 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9280 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9281 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9284 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9285 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9286 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9287 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9289 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9290 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9291 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9293 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9294 appear, for example:
9296 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9298 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9299 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9301 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9303 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9306 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9307 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9310 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9311 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9312 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9313 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9314 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9315 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9316 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9317 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9319 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9322 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9323 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9324 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9325 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9326 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9327 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9328 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9329 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9330 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9332 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9333 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9334 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9337 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9338 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9340 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9341 appear, for example:
9343 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9345 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9346 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9349 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9350 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9351 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9352 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9353 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9354 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9355 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9356 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9357 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9358 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9359 <&'string3'&> as before.
9361 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9362 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9363 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9364 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9365 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9366 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9367 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9368 provided. For example:
9370 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9374 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9376 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9377 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9380 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9381 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9382 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9384 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9385 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9386 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9387 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9388 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9389 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9390 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9392 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9394 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9395 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9398 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9399 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9400 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9401 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9402 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9403 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9405 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9406 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9407 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9408 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9410 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9412 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9413 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9414 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9415 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9416 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9418 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9420 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9421 letters appear. For example:
9423 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9424 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9425 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9428 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9429 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9430 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9431 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9432 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9433 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9434 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9435 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9436 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9437 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9438 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9439 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9440 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9441 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9445 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9446 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9447 lines) may be present.
9449 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9450 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9453 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9454 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9455 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9458 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9459 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9460 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9461 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9462 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9463 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9464 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9465 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9468 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9469 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9470 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9471 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9472 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9473 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9476 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9477 command of the following form:
9479 headers charset "UTF-8"
9481 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9482 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9483 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9484 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9485 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9488 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9489 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9490 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9491 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9493 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9494 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9495 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9496 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9497 router or transport are not accessible.
9499 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9500 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9501 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9502 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9503 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9504 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9505 point they are added.
9506 When any of the above ACLs ar
9507 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9509 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9510 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9511 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9512 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9513 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9514 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9515 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9518 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9519 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9520 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9521 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9522 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9523 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9524 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9525 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9528 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9529 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9531 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9532 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9533 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9534 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9535 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9536 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9537 present. For example:
9539 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9541 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9544 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9546 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9547 an Exim configuration:
9549 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9551 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9554 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9555 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9556 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9558 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9559 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9560 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9561 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9562 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9563 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9566 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9567 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9568 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9569 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9570 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9571 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9573 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9575 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9576 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9577 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9578 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9579 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9581 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9582 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9583 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9585 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9589 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9594 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9595 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9596 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9597 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9598 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9599 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9603 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9604 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9605 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9606 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9607 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9608 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9609 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9612 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9614 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9615 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9616 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9619 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9620 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9621 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9622 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9623 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9624 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9625 apart from an optional leading minus,
9626 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9628 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9629 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9631 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9632 If the number is negative, the fields are
9633 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9634 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9635 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9637 If the modulus of the
9638 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9639 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9643 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9647 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9649 yields &"result: 42"&.
9651 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9652 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9654 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9657 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9658 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9659 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9660 described in the next item.
9662 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9663 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9664 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9665 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9666 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9667 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9668 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9669 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9670 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9672 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9673 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9674 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9675 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9676 out by the system administrator.
9679 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9680 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9681 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9682 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9683 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9684 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9685 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9686 original lookup fails.
9688 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9689 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9690 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9691 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9692 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9693 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9694 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9695 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9697 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9698 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9699 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9700 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9702 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9703 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9704 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9705 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9707 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9709 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9711 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9712 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9714 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9719 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9720 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9722 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9723 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9724 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9725 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9726 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9727 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9729 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9731 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9732 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9733 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9735 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9736 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9737 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9738 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9739 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9740 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9741 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9743 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9745 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9746 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9747 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9748 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9751 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9753 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9757 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9758 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9759 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9760 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9761 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9762 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9763 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9764 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9766 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9767 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9768 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9769 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9770 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9773 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9774 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9775 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9777 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9778 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9781 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9782 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9783 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9784 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9785 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9786 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9787 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9788 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9790 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9791 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9792 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9793 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9794 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9795 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9796 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9797 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9798 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9799 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9801 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9802 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9803 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9804 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9806 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9807 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9808 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9809 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9810 is the expansion of the third argument.
9812 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9813 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9814 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9816 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9817 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9818 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9819 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9820 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9821 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9822 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9823 newlines are left in the string.
9824 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9825 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9826 the string expansion fails.
9828 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9829 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9833 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9834 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9835 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9836 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9837 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9838 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9839 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9842 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9843 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9845 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9846 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9847 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9848 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9849 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9852 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9854 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9855 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9856 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9857 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9858 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9859 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9860 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9862 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9864 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9865 and must be present if the argument is given.
9866 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9867 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9868 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9869 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9871 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9873 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9874 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9875 turns them into spaces:
9877 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9879 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9880 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9881 addition, the following errors can occur:
9884 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9886 Failure to connect the socket;
9888 Failure to write the request string;
9890 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9893 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9894 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9895 errors occurs. For example:
9897 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9900 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9901 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9902 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9903 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9904 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9906 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9907 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9910 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9911 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9912 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9915 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9916 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9917 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9918 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9919 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9920 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9921 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9922 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9923 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9925 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9927 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9930 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9932 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9933 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9936 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9937 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9938 expansion item above.
9940 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9941 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9942 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9943 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9944 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9945 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9946 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9947 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9948 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9950 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9951 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9952 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9953 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9954 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9955 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9956 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9957 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9958 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9961 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9962 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9963 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9965 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9966 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9967 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9968 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9969 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9972 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9973 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9974 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9975 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9977 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9978 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9979 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9982 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9983 log_message = Output of id: $value
9985 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9986 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9988 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9992 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9993 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9995 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9996 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10000 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10001 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10004 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10005 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10006 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10007 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10009 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10010 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10013 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10014 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10015 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10016 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10017 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10018 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10019 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10020 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10022 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10024 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10025 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10026 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10028 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10030 yields &"defabc"&, and
10032 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10034 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10035 the regular expression from string expansion.
10039 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10040 .cindex sorting "a list"
10041 .cindex list sorting
10042 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10043 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10044 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10045 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10046 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10047 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10048 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10049 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10050 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10051 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10052 to give values for comparison.
10054 The item result is a sorted list,
10055 with the original list separator,
10056 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10060 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10062 sorts a list of numbers, and
10064 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10066 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10069 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10070 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10071 .cindex "substring extraction"
10072 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10073 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10074 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10075 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10076 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10078 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10080 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10081 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10084 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10085 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10086 length required. For example
10088 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10090 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10091 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10092 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10093 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10095 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10096 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10097 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10099 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10101 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10102 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10103 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10105 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10107 yields an empty string, but
10109 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10113 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10114 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10115 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10116 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10119 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10121 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10125 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10126 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10127 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10128 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10129 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10130 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10131 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10132 replacement list. For example
10134 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10136 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10137 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10138 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10144 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10145 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10146 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10147 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10148 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10149 following operations can be performed:
10152 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10153 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10154 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10155 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10156 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10157 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10160 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10161 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10162 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10163 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10164 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10165 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10166 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10167 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10168 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10170 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10171 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10172 character. For example:
10174 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10176 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10177 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10178 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10179 separator explicitly:
10181 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10184 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10185 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10186 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10189 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10190 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10191 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10192 email address separator. For the example header line:
10194 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10196 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10197 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10198 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10199 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10200 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10201 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10204 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10205 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10207 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10208 Last:user@example.com
10209 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10213 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10214 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10215 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10216 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10217 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10218 Only lowercase letters are used.
10220 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10221 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10222 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10223 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10224 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10226 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10227 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10228 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10229 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10230 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10231 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10232 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10233 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10234 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10236 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10237 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10238 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10239 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10240 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10241 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10244 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10245 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10246 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10247 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10248 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10249 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10251 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10252 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10255 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10256 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10257 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10258 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10259 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10262 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10263 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10264 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10265 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10266 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10269 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10270 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10271 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10272 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10273 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10274 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10275 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10277 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10278 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10279 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10280 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10281 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10282 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10285 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10286 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10287 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10288 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10289 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10290 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10291 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10292 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10293 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10294 C programming language):
10296 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10297 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10298 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10299 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10300 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10302 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10304 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10305 space is permitted before or after operators.
10307 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10308 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10309 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10310 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10311 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10313 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10315 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10316 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10319 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10320 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10321 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10322 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10323 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10324 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10325 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10326 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10327 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10328 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10329 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10332 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10334 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10337 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10340 {$recipients_count} \
10341 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10345 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10346 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10349 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10350 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10351 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10354 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10356 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10357 and then re-expands what it has found.
10360 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10362 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10363 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10364 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10365 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10366 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10367 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10368 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10369 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10370 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10372 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10373 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10374 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10375 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10376 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10377 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10378 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10381 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10382 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10383 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10384 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10385 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10386 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10388 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10390 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10391 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10395 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10396 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10397 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10398 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10399 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10400 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10404 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10405 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10406 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10407 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10408 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10409 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10410 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10413 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10414 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10415 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10416 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10417 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10418 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10419 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10421 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10422 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10423 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10424 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10425 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10426 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10427 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10428 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10429 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10432 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10433 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10434 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10435 .cindex "lower casing"
10436 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10437 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10438 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10443 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10444 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10445 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10446 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10447 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10448 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10450 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10452 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10453 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10454 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10457 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10458 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10459 .cindex "list" "item count"
10460 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10461 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10462 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10465 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10466 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10467 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10468 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10469 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10470 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10471 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10472 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10473 matching list is returned.
10476 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10477 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10478 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10479 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10480 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10484 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10485 .cindex "masked IP address"
10486 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10487 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10488 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10489 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10490 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10491 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10492 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10493 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10494 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10496 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10498 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10499 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10500 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10501 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10503 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10507 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10509 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10512 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10514 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10515 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10516 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10517 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10518 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10520 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10521 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10524 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10525 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10526 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10527 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10528 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10529 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10531 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10533 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10536 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10537 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10538 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10539 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10540 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10541 is an empty string or
10542 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10543 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10544 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10545 respectively For example,
10553 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10554 variable or a message header.
10556 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10557 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10558 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10559 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10560 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10561 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10562 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10565 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10566 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10567 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10568 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10569 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10571 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10577 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10578 yields an unchanged string.
10581 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10582 .cindex "random number"
10583 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10584 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10585 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10586 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10587 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10588 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10589 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10590 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10594 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10595 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10596 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10597 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10598 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10599 for DNS. For example,
10601 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10602 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10607 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10611 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10612 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10613 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10614 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10615 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10616 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10617 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10618 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10619 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10622 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10624 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10625 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10629 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10630 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10631 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10632 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10633 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10634 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10635 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10636 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10638 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10639 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10640 to use this operator as well.
10644 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10645 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10646 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10647 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10648 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10649 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10650 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10653 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10654 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10655 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10656 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10657 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10658 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10659 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10661 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10662 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10665 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10666 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10667 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10668 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10669 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10670 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10672 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10674 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10675 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10678 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10679 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10680 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10681 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10682 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10683 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10685 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10687 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10688 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10689 with 256 being the default.
10691 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10692 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10694 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10695 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10699 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10700 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10701 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10702 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10703 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10704 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10705 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10706 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10707 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10708 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10709 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10710 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10711 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10713 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10714 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10715 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10717 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10718 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10719 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10723 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10724 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10725 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10726 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10727 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10728 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10731 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10732 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10733 .cindex "substring extraction"
10734 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10735 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10736 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10737 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10739 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10741 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10742 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10744 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10745 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10746 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10747 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10750 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10751 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10752 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10753 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10754 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10755 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10758 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10759 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10760 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10761 .cindex "upper casing"
10762 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10763 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10764 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10766 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10767 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10768 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10769 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10770 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10771 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10772 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10774 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10775 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10776 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10777 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10778 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10779 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10781 .cindex internationalisation
10782 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10783 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10784 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10785 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10786 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10787 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10795 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10796 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10797 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10798 while expanding strings:
10801 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10802 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10803 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10804 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10807 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10808 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10809 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10810 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10816 &`>= `& greater or equal
10818 &`<= `& less or equal
10822 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10824 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10825 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10826 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10827 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10828 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10831 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10832 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10833 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10836 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10837 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10838 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10839 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10840 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10841 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10842 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10843 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10844 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10845 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10846 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10847 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10848 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10849 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10851 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10852 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10853 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10854 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10855 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10856 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10858 An empty string is treated as false.
10859 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10860 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10861 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10863 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10864 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10867 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10871 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10872 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10873 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10874 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10875 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10876 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10877 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10878 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10880 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10882 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10883 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10884 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10885 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10886 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10887 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10888 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10889 included in the binary.
10891 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10892 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10893 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10894 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10895 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10896 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10897 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10898 string in LDAP form is:
10900 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10902 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10903 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10905 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10907 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10912 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10913 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10914 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10915 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10916 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10917 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10921 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10922 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10923 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10924 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10925 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10926 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10929 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10930 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10931 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10932 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10933 whatever its length.
10936 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10937 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10938 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10939 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10941 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10942 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10943 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10944 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10945 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10946 support &[crypt16()]&.
10948 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10949 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10950 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10951 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10952 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10954 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10955 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10956 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10958 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10959 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10960 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10961 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10962 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10964 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10965 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10966 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10967 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10968 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10969 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10971 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10973 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10974 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10976 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10977 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10978 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10979 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10980 exists in the message. For example,
10982 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10984 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10985 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10987 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10988 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10989 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10990 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10991 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10992 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10993 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10994 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10995 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10997 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10998 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10999 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11000 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11001 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11002 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11003 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11004 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11006 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11007 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11008 .cindex "first delivery"
11009 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11010 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11011 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11012 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11015 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11016 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11017 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11018 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11019 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11021 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11022 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11023 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11024 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11025 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11027 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11028 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11029 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11031 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11032 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11033 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11035 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11036 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11037 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11038 list separator is changed to a comma:
11040 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11042 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11043 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11045 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11048 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11049 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11050 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11051 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11052 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11053 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11054 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11055 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11056 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11059 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11060 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11061 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11062 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11063 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11064 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11065 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11066 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11067 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11070 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11071 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11072 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11073 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11074 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11075 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11078 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11079 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11081 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11082 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11083 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11084 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11087 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11088 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11089 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11090 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11091 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11092 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11093 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11094 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11095 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11096 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11097 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11099 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11100 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11101 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11102 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11103 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11105 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11106 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11108 This is no longer the case.
11110 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11111 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11113 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11115 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11117 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11118 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11119 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11120 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11121 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11122 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11123 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11124 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11125 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11126 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11127 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11128 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11129 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11133 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11134 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11135 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11136 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11137 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11138 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11139 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11140 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11141 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11144 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11145 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11146 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11147 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11148 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11149 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11150 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11151 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11152 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11156 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11157 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11158 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11159 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11160 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11161 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11162 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11163 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11164 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11165 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11166 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11169 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11171 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11172 backslashes is also required.
11174 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11175 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11176 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11177 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11178 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11179 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11181 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11182 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11183 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11184 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11185 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11186 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11187 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11188 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11190 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11191 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11192 See &*match_local_part*&.
11194 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11195 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11196 See &*match_local_part*&.
11198 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11199 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11200 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11201 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11202 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11203 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11205 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11207 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11210 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11212 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11214 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11215 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11216 in a single test such as
11217 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11218 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11219 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11220 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11222 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11224 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11226 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11228 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11229 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11230 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11231 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11232 masks. For example:
11234 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11236 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11237 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11238 address mask, for example:
11240 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11242 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11243 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11245 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11249 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11250 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11252 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11254 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11255 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11256 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11257 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11258 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11259 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11260 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11261 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11264 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11266 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11267 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11268 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11269 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11271 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11273 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11274 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11275 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11276 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11279 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11280 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11282 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11283 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11284 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11285 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11287 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11288 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11289 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11290 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11291 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11292 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11293 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11294 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11295 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11296 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11297 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11301 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11302 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11304 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11305 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11306 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11307 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11308 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11309 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11310 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11312 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11313 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11314 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11315 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11316 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11318 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11320 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11322 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11324 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11325 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11326 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11327 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11328 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11329 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11330 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11331 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11334 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11335 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11337 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11338 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11339 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11340 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11341 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11342 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11344 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11345 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11346 building Exim. For example:
11348 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11350 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11351 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11352 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11353 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11355 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11356 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11357 configuration, you might have this:
11359 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11361 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11363 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11365 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11366 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11367 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11368 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11369 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11370 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11373 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11375 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11376 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11377 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11378 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11379 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11382 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11383 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11384 this library, you need to set
11386 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11388 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11389 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11391 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11393 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11394 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11395 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11397 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11398 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11399 the authentication is successful. For example:
11401 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11405 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11406 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11407 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11409 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11410 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11411 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11412 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11413 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11414 by a process that is not running as root.
11416 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11417 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11418 building Exim. For example:
11420 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11422 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11423 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11424 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11426 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11427 two are mandatory. For example:
11429 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11431 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11432 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11433 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11438 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11439 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11440 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11441 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11442 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11443 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11444 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11448 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11449 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11450 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11451 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11452 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11455 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11457 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11458 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11459 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11461 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11462 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11463 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11464 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11465 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11466 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11467 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11468 parsed but not evaluated.
11470 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11475 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11476 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11477 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11478 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11479 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11482 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11483 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11484 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11485 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11486 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11487 In the expansion condition case
11488 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11489 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11490 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11491 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11492 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11493 matching condition.
11495 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11496 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11497 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11498 any unused variables being made empty.
11500 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11501 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11502 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11503 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11504 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11505 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11506 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11507 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11508 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11509 during subsequent delivery.
11511 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11512 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11513 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11514 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11515 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11516 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11517 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11518 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11521 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11522 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11523 this variable has the number of arguments.
11525 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11526 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11527 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11528 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11529 be preserved by coding like this:
11531 warn !verify = sender
11532 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11534 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11535 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11538 .vitem &$address_data$&
11539 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11540 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11541 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11542 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11543 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11544 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11547 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11548 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11549 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11550 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11551 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11552 from the child's routing.
11554 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11555 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11556 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11559 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11560 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11561 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11563 .vitem &$address_file$&
11564 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11565 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11566 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11567 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11568 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11570 /home/r2d2/savemail
11572 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11573 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11574 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11575 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11576 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11577 to the relevant file.
11579 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11580 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11581 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11582 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11584 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11585 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11586 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11587 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11589 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11590 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11591 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11592 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11593 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11594 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11595 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11596 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11597 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11599 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11600 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11601 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11602 command line option.
11604 This second case also sets up inforamtion used by the
11605 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11608 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11609 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11610 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11611 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11612 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11613 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11614 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11615 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11616 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11620 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11621 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11622 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11623 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11624 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11625 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11626 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11627 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11628 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11629 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11630 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11632 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11633 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11634 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11635 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11636 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11639 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11640 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11641 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11642 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11643 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11644 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11645 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11646 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11647 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11648 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11649 an undefined mechanism.
11651 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11652 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11653 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11654 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11655 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11656 the ACL malware condition.
11658 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11659 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11660 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11661 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11662 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11663 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11665 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11666 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11667 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11668 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11669 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11670 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11671 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11673 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11674 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11675 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11676 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11677 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11679 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11680 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11681 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11682 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11683 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11685 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11686 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11687 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11688 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11689 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11690 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11691 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11693 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11694 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11695 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11696 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11697 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11698 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11699 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11701 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11702 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11703 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11704 address that was connected to.
11706 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11707 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11708 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11709 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11710 compilations of the same version of the program.
11712 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11713 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11714 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11715 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11716 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11717 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11719 .vitem &$config_file$&
11720 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11721 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11723 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11724 Results of DKIM verification.
11725 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11727 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11728 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11729 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11730 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11731 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11733 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11734 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11735 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11736 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11737 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11738 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11739 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11740 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11741 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11742 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11743 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11744 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11745 &$dkim_key_length$&
11746 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11747 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11749 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11750 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11751 When a message has been received this variable contains
11752 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11753 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11755 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11756 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11757 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11759 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11760 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11761 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11762 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11763 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11764 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11765 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11766 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11767 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11770 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11771 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11772 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11773 case for &$domain$&.
11775 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11776 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11777 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11778 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11780 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11781 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11782 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11783 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11784 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11785 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11787 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11788 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11789 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11791 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11794 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11795 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11796 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11797 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11798 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11799 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11800 the &(smtp)& transport.
11803 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11804 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11805 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11806 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11809 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11810 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11811 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11812 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11813 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11814 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11817 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11818 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11819 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11820 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11824 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11825 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11826 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11827 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11828 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11829 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11830 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11833 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11834 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11835 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11838 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11839 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11840 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11842 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11843 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11844 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11846 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11847 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11848 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11850 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11851 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11852 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11853 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11854 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11855 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11857 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11858 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11859 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11860 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11861 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11863 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11864 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11865 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11866 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11867 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11871 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11872 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11873 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11874 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11875 by a setting on the transport itself.
11877 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11878 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11879 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11883 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11884 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11885 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11886 to local and remote transports.
11888 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11889 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11890 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11891 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11892 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11893 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11894 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11897 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11898 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11899 client is connected.
11902 .vitem &$host_address$&
11903 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11904 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11905 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11906 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11908 .vitem &$host_data$&
11909 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11910 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11911 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11912 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11914 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11915 message = $host_data
11917 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11918 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11919 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11920 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11921 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11922 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11923 variables is set to &"1"&.
11926 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11927 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11930 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11931 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11932 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11935 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11936 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11937 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11938 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11939 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11940 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11941 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11942 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11943 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11944 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11947 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
11948 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
11949 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11953 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11954 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11955 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11957 .vitem &$host_port$&
11958 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11959 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11960 for an outbound connection.
11962 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11963 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11964 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11965 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11966 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11967 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11970 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11971 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11972 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11973 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11974 a unique name for the file.
11976 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11977 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11978 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11980 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11981 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11982 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11986 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11987 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11988 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11992 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11993 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11994 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11997 .vitem &$load_average$&
11998 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11999 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12000 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12001 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12003 .vitem &$local_part$&
12004 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12005 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12006 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12007 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12008 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12010 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12011 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12012 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12013 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12016 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12017 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12018 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12019 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12020 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12021 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12023 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12024 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12025 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12028 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12029 local part of the recipient address.
12031 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12032 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12033 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12035 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12038 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12039 abc\:xyz@test.example
12041 the value of &$local_part$& is
12045 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12046 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12049 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12051 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12052 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12053 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12055 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12056 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12057 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12058 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12059 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12060 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12061 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12063 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12064 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12065 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12066 variable expands to nothing.
12068 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12069 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12070 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12071 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12072 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12074 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12075 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12076 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12077 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12078 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12080 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12081 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12082 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12083 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12085 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12086 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12087 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12089 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12090 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12091 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12092 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12093 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12094 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12095 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12096 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12098 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12099 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12100 This contains the expanded value of the
12101 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12104 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12105 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12106 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12107 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12108 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12109 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12111 .vitem &$log_space$&
12112 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12113 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12114 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12115 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12116 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12117 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12120 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12121 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12122 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12123 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12124 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12125 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12126 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12127 and &"yes"& if it was.
12128 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12129 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12130 as authenticated data.
12132 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12133 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12134 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12135 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12136 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12137 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12138 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12141 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12142 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12143 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12144 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12145 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12147 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12148 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12149 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12150 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12151 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12152 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12154 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12156 .vitem &$message_age$&
12157 .cindex "message" "age of"
12158 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12159 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12160 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12163 .vitem &$message_body$&
12164 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12165 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12166 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12167 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12168 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12169 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12170 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12171 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12172 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12174 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12175 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12176 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12177 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12178 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12180 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12181 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12182 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12183 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12184 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12185 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12188 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12189 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12190 .cindex "message body" "size"
12191 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12192 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12193 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12194 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12195 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12197 If the spool file is wireformat
12198 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12199 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12201 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12202 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12203 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12204 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12205 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12206 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12207 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12208 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12210 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12211 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12212 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12213 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12214 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12215 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12217 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12218 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12219 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12220 contents of header lines is done.
12222 .vitem &$message_id$&
12223 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12225 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12226 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12227 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12228 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12229 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12230 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12231 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12232 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12233 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12234 from the body is not counted.
12236 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12237 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12238 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12239 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12240 header and the body).
12242 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12244 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12246 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12248 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12249 message has not yet been received.
12251 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12253 .vitem &$message_size$&
12254 .cindex "size" "of message"
12255 .cindex "message" "size"
12256 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12257 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12258 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12259 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12260 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12261 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12262 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12263 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12264 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12266 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12267 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12268 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12269 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12271 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12272 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12273 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12274 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12276 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12277 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12278 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12280 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12281 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12282 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12283 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12284 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12285 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12286 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12287 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12288 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12289 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12291 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12292 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12293 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12295 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12296 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12297 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12298 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12299 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12300 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12301 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12302 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12303 the original address.
12305 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12306 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12307 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12308 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12309 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12311 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12312 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12313 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12315 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12316 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12317 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12318 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12319 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12320 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12321 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12322 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12323 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12325 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12326 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12327 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12328 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12329 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12330 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12331 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12332 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12335 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12336 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12337 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12338 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12340 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12341 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12342 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12343 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12346 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12348 This variable contains the current process id.
12350 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12351 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12352 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12353 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12354 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12355 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12356 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12357 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12358 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12359 variable"& error if encountered.
12361 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12362 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12363 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12364 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12365 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12366 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12367 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12370 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12371 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12372 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12373 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12375 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12377 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12379 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12380 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12381 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12382 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12384 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12385 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12386 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12387 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12389 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12390 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12391 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12392 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12394 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12395 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12396 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12397 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12399 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12400 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12401 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12403 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12404 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12405 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12406 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12408 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12409 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12410 .cindex "named queues"
12411 .cindex queues named
12412 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12414 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12415 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12416 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12417 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12418 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12420 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12421 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12422 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12423 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12424 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12425 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12427 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12428 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12429 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12430 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12431 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12433 .vitem &$received_count$&
12434 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12435 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12436 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12437 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12440 .vitem &$received_for$&
12441 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12442 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12443 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12444 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12445 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12447 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12448 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12449 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12450 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12451 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12452 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12453 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12456 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12457 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12458 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12459 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12460 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12462 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12464 .vitem &$received_port$&
12465 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12466 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12468 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12469 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12470 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12471 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12472 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12473 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12474 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12475 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12476 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12478 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12479 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12480 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12481 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12482 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12483 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12485 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12486 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12487 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12489 .vitem &$received_time$&
12490 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12491 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12492 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12494 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12495 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12496 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12497 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12498 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12500 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12501 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12503 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12504 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12505 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12506 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12508 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12509 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12510 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12511 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12514 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12515 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12518 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12521 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12522 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12526 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12529 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12532 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12533 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12535 .vitem &$recipients$&
12536 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12537 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12538 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12539 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12540 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12544 In a system filter file.
12546 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12547 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12548 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12549 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12551 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12555 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12556 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12557 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12558 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12559 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12560 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12563 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12564 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12565 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12566 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12568 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12569 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12570 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12571 these variables contain the
12572 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12575 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12576 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12577 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12578 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12579 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12580 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12581 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12583 .vitem &$return_path$&
12584 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12585 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12586 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12587 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12588 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12589 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12590 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12591 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12592 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12593 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12596 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12597 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12598 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12600 .vitem &$router_name$&
12601 .cindex "router" "name"
12602 .cindex "name" "of router"
12603 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12604 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12607 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12608 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12609 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12610 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12611 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12612 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12613 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12616 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12617 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12618 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12619 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12620 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12621 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12622 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12623 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12625 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12626 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12627 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12628 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12629 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12630 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12632 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12633 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12634 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12635 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12636 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12637 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12638 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12639 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12641 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12642 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12643 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12645 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12646 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12647 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12649 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12650 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12651 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12652 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12653 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12656 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12657 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12659 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12660 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12661 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12662 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12664 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12665 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12666 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12667 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12668 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12669 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12670 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12671 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12672 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12673 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12674 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12675 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12676 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12678 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12679 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12680 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12681 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12682 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12684 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12685 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12686 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12687 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12688 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12689 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12691 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12692 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12693 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12694 this variable contains that
12695 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12697 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12698 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12699 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12700 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12701 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12702 &$authenticated_id$&.
12704 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12705 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12706 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12707 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12708 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12709 resolver library states that both
12710 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12711 other times, this variable is false.
12713 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12714 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12715 library, by setting:
12720 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12721 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12723 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12724 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12726 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12727 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12728 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12729 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12732 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12733 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12734 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12735 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12736 other means, this variable is empty.
12738 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12739 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12740 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12741 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12742 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12743 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12744 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12746 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12747 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12748 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12749 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12751 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12752 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12753 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12756 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12757 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12758 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12759 following are true:
12762 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12764 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12765 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12766 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12768 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12769 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12770 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12772 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12773 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12774 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12776 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12777 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12778 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12779 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12781 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12783 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12784 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12788 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12789 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12790 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12791 number that was used on the remote host.
12793 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12794 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12795 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12796 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12797 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12800 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12801 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12802 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12803 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12805 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12806 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12807 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12808 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12809 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12810 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12811 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12812 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12813 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12814 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12815 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12818 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12819 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12820 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12821 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12822 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12824 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12825 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12826 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12827 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12828 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12830 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12831 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12832 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12833 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12834 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12835 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12836 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12838 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12839 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12840 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12841 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12842 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12844 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12845 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12846 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12847 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12848 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12849 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12851 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12852 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12853 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12854 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12855 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12860 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12861 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12862 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12863 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12865 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12866 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12867 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12868 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12869 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12870 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12871 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12873 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12874 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12875 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12876 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12877 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12880 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12881 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12882 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12883 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12884 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12885 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12886 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12887 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12888 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12889 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12890 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12892 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12893 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12894 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12895 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12896 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12897 message is junk mail.
12899 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12900 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12901 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12902 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12905 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12906 &$spf_received$& &&&
12908 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
12909 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12910 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12911 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12914 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12915 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12916 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12918 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12919 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12920 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12921 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12922 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12923 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12925 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12926 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12927 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12928 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12929 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12930 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12931 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12932 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12934 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12936 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12939 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12940 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12941 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12942 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12943 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12944 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12946 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12947 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12948 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12949 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12950 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12951 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12952 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12953 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12955 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12956 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12959 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12960 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12961 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12962 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12963 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12964 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12966 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12967 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12968 .cindex certificate variables
12969 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12970 inbound connection when the message was received.
12971 It is only useful as the argument of a
12972 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12973 or a &%def%& condition.
12975 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
12976 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12978 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12979 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12980 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12981 inbound connection when the message was received.
12982 It is only useful as the argument of a
12983 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12984 or a &%def%& condition.
12985 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12986 which is not the leaf.
12988 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12989 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12990 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12991 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12992 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12993 or a &%def%& condition.
12995 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12996 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12997 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12998 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12999 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13000 or a &%def%& condition.
13001 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13002 which is not the leaf.
13004 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13005 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13006 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13007 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13009 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13010 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13013 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13014 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13015 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13016 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13017 and &"0"& otherwise.
13019 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13020 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13021 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13022 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13023 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13024 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13025 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13026 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13027 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13029 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13030 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13031 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13033 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13034 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13036 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13037 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13038 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13039 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13041 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13042 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13043 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13045 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13046 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13047 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13048 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13050 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13051 1 No response to request
13052 2 Response not verified
13053 3 Verification failed
13054 4 Verification succeeded
13057 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13058 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13059 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13060 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13061 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13063 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13064 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13065 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13066 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13067 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13068 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13069 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13070 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13071 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13072 which is not the leaf.
13074 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13075 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13078 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13079 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13080 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13081 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13082 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13083 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13084 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13085 which is not the leaf.
13087 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13088 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13089 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13090 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13091 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13092 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13093 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13094 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13095 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13096 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13097 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13099 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13100 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13103 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13104 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13105 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13107 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13110 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13111 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13112 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13114 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13115 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13116 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13117 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13119 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13120 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13121 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13123 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13124 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13125 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13127 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13128 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13129 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13130 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13131 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13132 values for those that are behind (west).
13135 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13136 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13137 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13139 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13140 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13141 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13142 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13145 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13146 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13147 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13150 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13151 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13152 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13153 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13155 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13156 .cindex "transport" "name"
13157 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13158 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13159 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13162 .vindex "&$value$&"
13163 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13164 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13165 &*reduce*& expansion.
13167 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13168 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13169 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13170 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13173 .vitem &$version_number$&
13174 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13175 The version number of Exim.
13177 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13178 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13179 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13180 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13182 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13183 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13184 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13185 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13191 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13192 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13194 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13195 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13196 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13197 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13198 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13199 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13204 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13207 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13208 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13209 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13210 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13211 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13212 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13213 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13214 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13215 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13217 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13218 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13219 should usually be something like
13221 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13223 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13224 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13225 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13226 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13227 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13228 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13229 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13230 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13234 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13235 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13236 a startup when Exim is entered.
13238 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13239 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13242 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13243 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13246 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13247 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13248 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13249 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13250 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13251 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13255 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13256 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13257 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13258 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13262 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13263 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13265 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13266 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13267 with an error message of the form
13269 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13271 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13272 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13273 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13274 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13275 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13276 that was passed to &%die%&.
13279 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13280 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13281 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13284 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13286 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13287 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13288 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13290 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13291 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13292 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13293 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13295 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13296 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13297 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13298 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13299 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13300 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13301 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13304 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13305 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13306 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13307 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13308 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13309 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13310 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13311 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13312 avoided, but the output is lost.
13314 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13315 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13316 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13317 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13318 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13319 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13320 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13322 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13324 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13325 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13326 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13327 as the first subroutine argument.
13331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13334 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13335 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13336 "Starting the daemon"
13337 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13338 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13339 .cindex "network interface"
13340 .cindex "interface" "network"
13341 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13342 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13343 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13344 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13345 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13346 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13347 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13348 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13349 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13350 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13351 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13354 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13355 and ports to listen on.
13357 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13358 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13359 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13360 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13361 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13362 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13363 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13364 as an error situation.
13366 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13367 for the outgoing connection.
13371 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13372 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13373 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13374 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13375 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13377 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13378 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13379 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13380 chapter describes how they operate.
13382 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13383 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13387 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13388 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13389 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13393 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13395 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13397 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13398 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13401 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13402 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13403 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13404 colons. For example:
13406 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13409 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13411 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13412 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13415 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13416 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13418 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13419 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13422 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13423 with a colon separator, for example:
13425 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13426 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13430 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13431 default setting contains just one port:
13433 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13435 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13436 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13437 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13438 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13439 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13443 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13444 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13445 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13446 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13447 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13448 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13450 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13452 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13454 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13456 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13460 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13461 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13462 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13463 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13464 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13465 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13468 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13469 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13470 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13471 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13472 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13473 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13477 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13480 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13482 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13483 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13484 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13488 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13489 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13490 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13491 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13492 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13493 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13494 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13495 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13496 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13497 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13498 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13499 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13500 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13503 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13504 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13505 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13507 The common use of this option is expected to be
13509 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13512 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13513 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13515 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13516 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13517 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13518 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13519 connections via the daemon.)
13524 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13525 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13526 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13527 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13528 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13529 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13530 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13531 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13533 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13535 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13536 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13537 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13538 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13539 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13540 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13542 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13544 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13545 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13546 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13547 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13548 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13550 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13551 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13552 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13553 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13554 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13555 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13556 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13557 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13558 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13559 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13560 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13561 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13563 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13564 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13565 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13566 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13567 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13571 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13572 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13574 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13575 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13577 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13578 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13579 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13580 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13582 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13584 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13586 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13588 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13589 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13591 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13592 IPv4 loopback address only:
13594 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13596 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13598 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13600 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13604 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13605 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13606 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13607 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13610 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13611 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13612 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13613 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13615 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13616 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13617 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13618 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13619 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13620 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13621 used for listening. Consider this example:
13623 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13625 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13627 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13629 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13630 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13633 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13634 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13635 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13636 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13637 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13638 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13639 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13640 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13644 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13645 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13646 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13647 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13648 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13649 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13658 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13659 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13660 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13661 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13664 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13665 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13667 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13668 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13669 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13671 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13672 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13673 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13674 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13678 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13679 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13680 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13681 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13682 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13683 listed in more than one group.
13685 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13687 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13688 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13689 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13690 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13691 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13692 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13693 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13694 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13695 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13696 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13697 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13701 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13703 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13704 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13705 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13706 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13707 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13708 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13713 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13715 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13716 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13717 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13718 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13719 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13720 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13721 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13722 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13723 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13724 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13725 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13726 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13731 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13733 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13734 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13735 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13736 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13737 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13738 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13739 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13740 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13741 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13742 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13743 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13744 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13745 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13746 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13747 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13752 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13754 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13755 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13756 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13757 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13762 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13764 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13765 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13766 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13767 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13768 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13769 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13770 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13771 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13772 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13773 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13774 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13775 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13776 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13777 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13778 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13783 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13785 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13786 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13791 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13793 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13794 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13795 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13800 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13802 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13803 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13804 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13805 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13806 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13807 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13808 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13813 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13815 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13816 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13817 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13818 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13819 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13820 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13821 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13822 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13823 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13824 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13825 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13826 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13827 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13828 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13829 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13830 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13832 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13833 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13834 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13835 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13836 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13841 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13843 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13844 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13845 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13846 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13847 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13848 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13849 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13850 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13851 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13852 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13853 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13854 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13855 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13856 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13857 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13858 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13859 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13860 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13861 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13862 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13863 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13864 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13866 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13867 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13868 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13869 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13870 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13871 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13872 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13873 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13874 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13875 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13876 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13877 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13878 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13879 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13880 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13881 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13882 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13883 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13884 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13889 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13891 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13893 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13895 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13896 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13897 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13902 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13904 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13905 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13906 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13907 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13908 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13909 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13910 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13911 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13912 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13913 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13914 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13915 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13916 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13917 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13918 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13919 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13920 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13925 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13927 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13928 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13929 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13930 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13931 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13932 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13933 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13934 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13939 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13941 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13942 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13943 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13944 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13945 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13946 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13947 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13948 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13954 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13956 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13963 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13964 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13967 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13968 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13969 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13970 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13971 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13972 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13973 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13974 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13975 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13976 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13977 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13978 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13979 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13980 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13981 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13983 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13984 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13985 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13986 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13987 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13988 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13989 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13990 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13991 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13992 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13993 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13994 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13995 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13996 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13997 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13998 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14003 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14005 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14006 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14007 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14008 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14009 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14010 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14011 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14012 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14013 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14014 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14019 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14021 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14022 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14023 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14024 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14026 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14027 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14028 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14029 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14030 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14031 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14032 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14033 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14034 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14035 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14040 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14042 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14043 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14045 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14046 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14047 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14048 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14049 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14054 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14056 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14057 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14058 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14059 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14060 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14061 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14062 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14063 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14064 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14065 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14066 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14067 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14068 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14069 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14070 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14071 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14072 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14073 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14074 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14075 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14076 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14077 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14078 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14079 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14084 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14086 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14087 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14088 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14089 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14090 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14091 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14092 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14093 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14094 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14095 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14096 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14097 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14098 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14099 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14100 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14105 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14106 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14109 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14111 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14112 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14113 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14114 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14115 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14116 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14117 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14119 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14120 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14121 It now defaults to true.
14122 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14124 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14127 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14129 log_selector = +8bitmime
14132 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14133 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14134 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14135 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14136 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14139 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14140 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14141 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14144 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14145 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14146 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14147 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14148 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14150 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14151 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14152 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14153 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14154 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14156 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14157 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14158 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14159 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14161 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14162 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14163 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14164 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14165 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14167 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14168 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14169 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14170 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14171 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14172 This option defines the ACL that,
14173 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14174 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14175 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14176 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14178 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14179 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14180 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14181 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14182 of a received message.
14183 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14185 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14186 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14187 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14188 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14190 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14191 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14192 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14193 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14195 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14196 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14197 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14198 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14199 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14202 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14203 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14204 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14205 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14207 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14208 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14209 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14210 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14211 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14213 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14214 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14215 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14216 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14217 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14219 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14220 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14221 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14222 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14223 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14225 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14226 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14227 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14230 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14231 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14232 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14233 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14235 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14236 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14237 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14238 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14240 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14241 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14242 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14243 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14245 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14246 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14247 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14248 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14250 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14251 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14252 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14253 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14254 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14256 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14257 .cindex "admin user"
14258 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14259 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14260 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14261 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14262 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14263 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14264 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14266 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14267 .cindex "domain literal"
14268 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14269 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14270 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14271 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14273 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14274 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14275 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14276 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14277 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14278 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14279 the local host's IP addresses.
14282 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14283 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14284 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14285 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14286 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14287 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14288 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14289 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14290 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14292 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14293 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14294 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14295 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14296 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14297 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14298 experiment if they wish.
14300 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14301 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14302 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14303 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14304 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14305 suitable setting is:
14307 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14308 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14310 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14312 dns_check_names_pattern =
14314 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14317 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14318 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14319 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14320 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14321 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14322 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14323 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14324 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14325 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14326 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14327 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14329 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14330 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14331 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14332 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14333 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14334 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14336 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14337 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14338 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14339 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14341 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14343 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14344 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14345 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14346 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14349 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14350 .cindex "thawing messages"
14351 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14352 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14353 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14354 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14355 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14356 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14358 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14359 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14360 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14363 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14364 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14365 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14367 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14369 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14370 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14373 .option bi_command main string unset
14375 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14376 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14377 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14378 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14381 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14382 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14383 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14384 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14385 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14386 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14389 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14390 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14391 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14392 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14394 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14395 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14396 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14397 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14398 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14399 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14400 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14401 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14402 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14403 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14405 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14406 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14407 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14408 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14409 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14410 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14411 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14412 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14413 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14414 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14416 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14417 during reception of a message.
14418 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14420 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14423 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14424 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14425 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14426 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14429 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14430 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14431 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14432 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14433 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14434 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14435 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14436 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14437 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14439 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14440 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14441 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14442 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14443 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14446 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14447 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14448 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14449 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14450 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14451 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14452 connection. A typical setting might be:
14454 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14456 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14458 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14460 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14463 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14464 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14465 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14466 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14467 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14468 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14471 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14472 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14473 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14474 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14477 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14478 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14479 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14480 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14483 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14484 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14485 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14486 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14489 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14490 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14491 callout verification. The default value is
14493 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14495 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14498 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14499 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14502 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14503 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14505 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14506 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14507 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14508 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14509 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14510 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14511 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14512 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14513 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14514 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14517 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14518 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14521 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14522 .cindex "checking disk space"
14523 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14524 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14525 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14526 message is accepted.
14528 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14529 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14530 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14531 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14532 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14533 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14534 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14535 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14538 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14539 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14541 check_spool_space = 100M
14542 check_spool_inodes = 100
14544 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14545 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14548 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14549 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14550 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14552 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14553 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14554 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14555 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14556 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14557 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14559 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14560 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14561 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14563 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14564 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14565 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14567 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14568 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14569 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14570 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14572 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14573 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14574 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14575 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14577 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14579 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14580 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14581 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14582 administrative user.
14583 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14585 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14586 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14587 .cindex memory debugging
14588 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14589 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14590 it should normally be left as default.
14592 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14593 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14594 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14595 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14596 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14597 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14599 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14600 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14601 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14602 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14603 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14604 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14605 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14607 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14608 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14610 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14611 .cindex "warning of delay"
14612 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14613 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14614 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14615 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14616 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14617 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14618 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14619 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14622 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14624 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14625 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14626 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14627 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14631 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14632 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14634 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14636 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14637 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14638 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14640 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14641 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14642 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14643 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14644 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14645 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14646 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14647 not sent. The default is:
14649 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14650 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14651 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14652 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14655 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14656 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14657 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14658 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14660 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14661 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14662 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14663 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14664 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14665 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14666 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14667 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14669 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14670 .cindex "load average"
14671 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14672 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14673 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14674 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14675 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14678 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14679 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14680 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14681 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14682 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14683 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14684 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14685 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14687 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14688 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14689 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14690 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14691 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14692 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14693 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14694 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14696 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14697 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14698 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14699 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14702 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14703 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14704 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14705 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14706 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14707 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14708 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14711 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14712 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14713 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14714 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14715 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14716 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14719 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14720 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14721 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14722 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14723 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14724 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14725 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14726 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14727 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14728 by a setting such as this:
14730 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14732 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14733 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14734 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14735 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14736 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14737 options are applied after this global option.
14739 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14740 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14741 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14742 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14743 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14744 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14745 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14746 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14747 value of this option. The default pattern is
14749 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14750 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14752 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14753 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14754 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14755 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14756 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14759 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14760 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14761 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14763 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14764 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14765 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14766 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14769 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14770 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14771 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14772 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14773 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14774 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14776 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14779 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14780 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14781 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14782 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14783 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14784 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14785 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14786 domain matches this list.
14788 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14789 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14790 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14793 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14794 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14795 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14796 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14797 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14798 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14799 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14800 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14801 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14802 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14803 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14804 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14806 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14809 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14810 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14813 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14814 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14815 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14816 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14817 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14818 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14819 match with this expanded domain list.
14821 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14822 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14823 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14824 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14825 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14826 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14828 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14829 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14830 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14832 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14833 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14834 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14835 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14836 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14838 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14839 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14840 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14841 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14842 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14843 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14844 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14845 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14848 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14850 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14851 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14852 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14855 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14856 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14857 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14858 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14860 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14861 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14862 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14863 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14864 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14865 and accepted from, these hosts.
14866 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14867 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14868 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14869 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14872 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14873 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14874 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14875 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14876 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14877 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14879 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14881 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14882 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14884 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14885 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14886 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14887 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14888 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14889 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14890 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14891 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14892 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14895 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14896 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14897 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14898 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14899 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14900 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14901 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14902 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14903 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14905 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14906 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14907 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14908 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14909 are examined. For example:
14911 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14912 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14913 postmaster@mydomain.example
14915 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14916 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14917 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14918 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14919 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14920 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14921 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14924 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14925 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14926 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14928 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14930 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14931 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14932 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14933 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14934 overrides the default.
14936 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14937 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14938 and warning messages. For example:
14940 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14942 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14943 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14944 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14945 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14949 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14951 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14952 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14955 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14956 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14957 .cindex "Exim group"
14958 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14959 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14960 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14961 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14962 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14966 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14967 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14968 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14969 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14970 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14971 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14973 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14974 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14975 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14976 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14979 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14980 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14981 .cindex "Exim user"
14982 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14983 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14984 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14985 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14987 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14988 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14989 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14990 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14993 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14994 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14995 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14996 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14999 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15000 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15002 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15003 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15005 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15006 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15007 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15008 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15009 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15010 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15011 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15012 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15013 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15014 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15018 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15019 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15020 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15021 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15022 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15023 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15024 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15025 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15028 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15029 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15030 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15031 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15035 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15036 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15037 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15038 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15039 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15040 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15041 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15042 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15043 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15044 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15045 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15046 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15047 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15048 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15049 logging that you require.
15052 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15054 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15055 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15056 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15057 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15058 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15059 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15060 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15061 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15063 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15064 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15065 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15068 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15069 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15070 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15071 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15073 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15077 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15078 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15081 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15082 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15083 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15084 implementations of TLS.
15087 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15088 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15089 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15092 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15097 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15098 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15099 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15100 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15101 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15102 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15106 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15107 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15108 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15109 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15110 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15111 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15112 sections are rejected.
15115 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15116 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15117 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15118 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15119 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15120 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15121 zero means &"no limit"&.
15126 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15127 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15128 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15129 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15130 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15131 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15132 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15133 if you want to do semantic checking.
15134 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15138 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15139 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15140 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15141 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15142 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15143 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15144 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15146 helo_allow_chars = _
15148 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15151 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15152 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15153 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15154 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15155 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15156 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15157 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15161 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15162 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15163 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15164 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15165 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15166 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15167 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15168 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15169 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15170 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15171 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15172 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15174 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15175 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15176 EHLO command either:
15179 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15181 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15182 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15183 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15184 calling host address, or
15186 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15189 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15190 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15191 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15193 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15194 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15195 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15197 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15198 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15199 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15200 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15201 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15202 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15203 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15204 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15205 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15208 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15209 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15210 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15211 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15212 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15213 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15214 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15215 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15216 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15218 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15219 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15220 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15221 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15222 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15224 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15225 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15226 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15227 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15230 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15231 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15232 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15233 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15234 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15235 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15236 default configuration file contains
15240 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15241 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15243 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15244 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15245 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15247 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15248 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15249 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15250 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15251 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15252 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15255 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15256 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15257 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15258 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15259 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15262 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15263 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15264 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15265 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15269 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15270 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15271 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15272 as soon as the connection is made.
15273 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15274 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15275 connections immediately.
15277 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15278 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15279 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15280 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15281 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15284 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15285 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15286 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15287 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15288 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15289 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15290 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15291 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15292 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15294 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15296 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15300 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15301 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15302 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15303 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15306 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15307 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15308 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15309 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15310 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15312 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15313 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15315 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15316 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15317 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15318 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15319 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15320 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15321 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15324 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15325 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15326 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15327 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15328 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15332 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15333 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15334 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15335 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15336 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15337 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15339 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15340 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15341 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15342 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15343 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15344 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15345 for frozen messages. For example,
15347 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15349 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15350 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15351 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15352 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15353 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15354 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15357 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15358 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15359 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15360 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15361 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15362 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15363 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15364 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15365 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15366 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15369 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15370 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15372 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15373 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15374 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15375 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15376 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15377 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15378 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15379 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15380 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15382 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15383 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15385 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15386 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15387 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15388 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15390 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15391 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15392 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15395 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15396 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15397 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15401 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15402 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15403 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15404 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15408 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15409 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15410 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15411 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15412 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15413 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15414 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15415 and constrained to be a directory.
15418 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15419 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15420 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15421 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15422 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15423 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15424 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15425 and constrained to be a file.
15428 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15429 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15430 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15431 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15432 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15433 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15436 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15437 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15438 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15439 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15440 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15441 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15442 identity to be proven.
15445 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15446 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15447 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15448 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15449 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15452 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15453 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15454 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15455 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15456 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15460 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15461 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15462 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15463 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15464 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15465 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15469 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15470 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15471 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15472 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15473 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15475 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15476 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15477 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15480 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15481 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15482 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15483 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15484 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15485 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15486 has been built with LDAP support.
15490 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15491 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15492 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15493 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15494 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15495 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15496 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15498 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15499 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15500 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15502 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15503 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15504 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15505 and the default qualify domain.
15507 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15508 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15509 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15510 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15512 .cindex "envelope sender"
15513 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15514 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15515 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15517 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15518 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15519 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15524 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15525 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15526 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15527 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15528 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15529 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15530 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15533 local_from_prefix = *-
15535 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15537 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15539 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15540 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15544 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15545 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15548 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15549 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15550 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15551 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15552 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15553 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15554 &%local_interfaces%& is
15556 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15558 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15560 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15563 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15564 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15565 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15566 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15567 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15568 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15569 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15570 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15574 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15575 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15576 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15577 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15578 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15579 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15580 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15581 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15586 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15587 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15588 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15589 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15590 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15591 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15592 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15593 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15594 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15595 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15596 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15597 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15598 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15599 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15600 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15604 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15605 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15606 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15607 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15608 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15609 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15610 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15611 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15612 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15613 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15614 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15615 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15616 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15617 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15618 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15621 .option log_selector main string unset
15622 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15623 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15624 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15625 minus characters. For example:
15627 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15629 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15630 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15633 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15634 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15635 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15636 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15637 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15638 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15639 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15640 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15641 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15642 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15643 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15644 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15645 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15648 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15649 .cindex "too many open files"
15650 .cindex "open files, too many"
15651 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15652 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15653 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15654 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15655 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15656 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15657 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15658 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15659 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15660 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15661 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15662 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15665 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15666 .cindex "length of login name"
15667 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15668 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15669 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15670 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15671 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15672 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15675 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15676 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15677 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15678 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15679 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15680 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15681 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15682 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15685 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15686 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15687 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15688 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15689 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15690 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15691 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15694 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15695 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15696 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15697 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15698 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15699 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15700 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15701 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15702 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15703 empty string, the option is ignored.
15706 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15707 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15708 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15709 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15710 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15711 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15712 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15713 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15714 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15715 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15716 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15717 colons will become hyphens.
15720 .option message_logs main boolean true
15721 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15722 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15723 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15724 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15725 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15726 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15727 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15728 which is not affected by this option.
15731 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15732 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15733 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15734 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15735 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15736 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15737 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15738 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15739 optionally followed by K or M.
15741 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15742 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15743 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15744 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15745 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15747 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15748 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15749 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15750 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15751 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15752 message that an individual transport can process.
15754 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15755 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15756 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15757 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15758 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15759 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15760 some problems may result.
15762 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15763 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15764 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15767 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15768 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15769 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15771 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15773 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15774 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15775 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15776 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15777 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15780 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15781 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15782 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15783 contains a full description of this facility.
15787 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15788 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15789 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15790 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15791 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15794 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15795 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15796 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15797 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15798 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15801 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15802 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15803 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15804 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15805 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15807 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15808 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15811 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15813 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15814 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15818 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15819 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15820 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15821 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15822 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15824 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15825 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15826 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15827 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15828 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15829 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15830 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15832 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15833 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15834 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15835 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15836 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15838 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15840 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15841 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15842 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15843 some now infamous attacks.
15847 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15848 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15849 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15851 # Disable older protocol versions:
15852 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15855 Possible options may include:
15859 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15861 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15863 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15867 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15869 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15871 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15873 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15875 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15877 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15881 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15895 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15899 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15901 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15903 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15905 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15909 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15912 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15913 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15914 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15915 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15916 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15917 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15920 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15921 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15922 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15923 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15924 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15927 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15928 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15929 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15930 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15931 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15932 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15933 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15934 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15935 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15936 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15939 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15940 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15941 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15942 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15943 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15944 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15945 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15948 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15950 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15951 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15954 .option perl_startup main string unset
15956 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15957 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15959 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15961 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15964 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15965 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15966 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15967 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15968 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15969 PostgreSQL support.
15972 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15973 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15974 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15975 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15976 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15979 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15981 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15983 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15984 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15985 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15988 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15989 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15990 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15991 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15992 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15993 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15994 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15995 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15996 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15999 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16000 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16001 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16002 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16003 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16004 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16005 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16006 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16008 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16009 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16010 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16011 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16012 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16013 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16014 volume of mail. Use with care!
16017 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16018 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16019 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16020 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16021 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16022 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16023 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16024 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16025 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16026 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16028 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16029 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16030 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16031 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16032 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16033 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16036 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16037 .cindex "printing characters"
16038 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16039 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16040 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16041 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16042 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16043 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16046 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16047 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16048 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16049 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16050 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16054 .option process_log_path main string unset
16055 .cindex "process log path"
16056 .cindex "log" "process log"
16057 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16058 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16059 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16060 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16061 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16062 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16063 different spool directories.
16066 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16067 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16071 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16072 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16073 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16076 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16077 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16078 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16079 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16080 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16081 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16082 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16083 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16084 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16086 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16087 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16088 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16089 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16090 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16091 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16092 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16095 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16096 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16097 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16101 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16102 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16103 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16104 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16105 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16106 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16107 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16108 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16111 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16112 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16114 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16115 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16116 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16117 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16120 .option queue_only main boolean false
16121 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16122 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16123 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16124 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16125 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16126 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16128 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16129 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16130 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16131 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16134 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16135 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16136 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16137 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16138 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16139 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16140 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16141 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16142 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16144 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16146 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16147 &_/some/file_& exists.
16150 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16151 .cindex "load average"
16152 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16153 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16154 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16155 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16156 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16157 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16158 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16161 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16162 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16163 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16164 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16167 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16168 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16169 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16170 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16171 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16172 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16173 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16174 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16175 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16176 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16177 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16178 re-evaluated for each message.
16181 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16182 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16183 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16184 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16185 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16186 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16189 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16190 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16191 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16192 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16193 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16194 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16195 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16196 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16197 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16198 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16199 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16200 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16201 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16205 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16206 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16207 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16208 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16209 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16210 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16211 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16212 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16213 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16215 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16216 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16217 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16218 the daemon's command line.
16220 .cindex queues named
16221 .cindex "named queues"
16222 To set limits for different named queues use
16223 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16225 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16226 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16227 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16228 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16229 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16230 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16231 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16232 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16233 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16234 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16235 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16236 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16237 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16241 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16242 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16243 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16244 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16245 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16246 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16247 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16249 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16250 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16251 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16252 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16253 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16254 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16255 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16256 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16257 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16258 header lines. The default setting is:
16261 received_header_text = Received: \
16262 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16263 {${if def:sender_ident \
16264 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16265 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16266 by $primary_hostname \
16267 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16268 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16269 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16270 ${if def:sender_address \
16271 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16272 id $message_exim_id\
16273 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16276 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16277 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16278 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16279 header lines such as the following:
16281 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16282 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16283 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16284 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16285 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16286 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16287 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16289 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16290 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16291 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16292 message was accepted.
16295 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16296 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16297 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16298 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16299 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16300 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16301 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16302 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16305 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16306 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16307 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16308 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16309 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16310 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16311 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16312 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16313 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16314 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16315 option was not set.
16318 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16319 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16320 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16321 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16322 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16323 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16324 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16325 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16328 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16329 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16330 RCPT commands in a single message.
16333 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16334 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16335 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16336 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16337 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16338 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16339 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16342 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16343 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16344 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16345 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16346 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16347 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16348 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16349 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16350 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16351 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16352 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16353 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16354 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16355 tagged with its process id.
16357 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16358 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16359 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16360 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16363 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16364 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16365 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16366 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16367 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16368 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16369 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16370 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16371 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16372 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16373 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16375 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16376 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16377 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16378 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16381 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16382 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16383 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16384 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16385 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16387 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16389 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16390 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16393 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16394 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16395 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16396 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16397 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16401 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16402 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16403 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16404 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16405 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16406 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16407 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16411 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16412 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16413 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16414 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16415 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16416 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16417 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16418 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16419 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16420 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16423 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16424 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16427 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16429 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16430 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16431 an item in the list.
16432 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16435 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16436 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16437 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16438 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16439 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16442 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16443 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16444 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16445 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16446 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16447 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16448 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16449 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16450 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16451 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16453 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16454 .cindex "environment"
16455 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16456 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16457 default list is empty,
16460 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16461 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16462 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16463 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16464 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16465 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16466 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16470 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16471 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16472 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16473 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16474 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16475 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16476 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16477 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16478 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16479 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16480 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16484 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16485 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16486 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16488 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16489 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16490 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16491 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16492 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16493 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16495 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16496 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16497 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16498 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16501 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16502 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16503 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16504 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16505 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16506 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16507 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16508 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16510 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16511 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16512 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16513 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16514 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16515 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16516 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16517 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16520 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16521 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16522 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16523 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16527 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16528 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16529 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16530 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16531 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16532 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16533 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16534 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16535 . the option name to split.
16537 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16538 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16539 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16540 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16541 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16542 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16543 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16544 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16545 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16549 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16550 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16551 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16552 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16553 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16554 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16555 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16556 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16557 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16558 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16559 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16561 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16562 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16563 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16564 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16565 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16566 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16570 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16571 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16572 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16573 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16574 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16575 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16576 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16577 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16578 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16579 to all messages received in the same connection.
16581 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16582 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16583 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16584 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16587 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16589 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16590 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16591 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16592 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16593 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16594 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16595 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16596 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16597 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16598 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16599 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16600 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16601 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16604 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16605 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16606 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16607 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16608 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16609 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16610 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16611 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16612 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16613 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16614 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16617 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16618 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16619 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16620 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16623 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16624 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16625 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16626 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16627 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16628 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16629 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16630 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16631 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16633 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16634 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16635 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16636 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16638 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16639 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16640 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16641 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16642 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16645 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16646 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16649 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16650 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16651 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16652 &%helo_data%& value.
16654 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16655 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16656 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16657 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16658 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16659 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16660 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16662 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16663 $version_number $tod_full
16665 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16666 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16667 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16668 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16669 multiline response).
16672 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16673 .cindex "checking disk space"
16674 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16675 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16676 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16677 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16678 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16679 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16680 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16683 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16684 .cindex "connection backlog"
16685 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16686 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16687 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16688 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16689 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16690 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16691 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16692 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16693 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16694 attacks by SYN flooding.
16697 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16698 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16699 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16700 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16701 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16702 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16703 fewer, but they still exist.
16705 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16706 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16707 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16708 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16709 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16710 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16711 does detect many instances.
16713 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16714 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16715 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16716 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16720 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16721 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16722 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16723 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16724 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16725 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16726 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16727 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16730 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16731 $sender_host_address
16733 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16734 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16735 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16736 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16737 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16741 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16742 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16743 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16744 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16745 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16748 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16749 .cindex "load average"
16750 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16751 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16752 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16753 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16754 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16755 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16759 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16760 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16761 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16762 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16763 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16765 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16767 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16768 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16769 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16770 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16771 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16773 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16774 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16775 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16776 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16777 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16778 not count towards the limit.
16782 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16783 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16784 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16785 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16786 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16789 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16790 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16794 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16795 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16796 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16797 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16798 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16799 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16802 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16803 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16804 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16805 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16807 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16808 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16809 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16810 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16814 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16816 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16817 fractional parts are allowed here.
16819 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16821 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16822 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16825 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16826 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16828 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16829 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16831 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16832 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16833 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16834 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16837 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16838 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16841 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16842 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16845 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16846 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16847 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16848 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16849 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16850 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16851 the message is abandoned.
16852 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16854 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16855 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16857 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16858 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16860 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16861 expanded before use and may depend on
16862 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16866 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16867 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16868 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16869 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16870 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16873 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16874 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16875 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16878 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16879 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16880 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16881 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16882 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16883 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16884 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16885 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16886 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16887 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16889 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16890 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16894 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16895 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16896 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16897 the availability thereof is advertised in
16898 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16899 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16902 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
16903 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16904 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16905 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16910 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
16911 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
16912 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
16917 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16918 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16919 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16920 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16921 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16922 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16923 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16924 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16925 arrival of the message.
16927 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16928 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16929 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16930 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16931 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16933 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16934 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16935 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16936 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16937 automatically deleted.
16939 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16940 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16941 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16942 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16943 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16944 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16945 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16946 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16947 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16950 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16951 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16952 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16953 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16954 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16955 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16956 &$primary_hostname$&.
16958 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16959 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16960 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16961 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16962 as failures in the configuration file.
16964 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16965 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16967 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16968 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16969 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16970 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16971 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16972 Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16975 The following variables will not have useful values:
16977 $max_received_linelength
16982 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16983 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16984 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16985 will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16987 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16988 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
16989 The transmission benefit is maintained.
16991 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16992 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16993 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16994 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16996 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16997 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16998 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16999 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17000 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17001 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17003 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17004 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17005 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17006 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17007 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17008 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17009 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17012 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17013 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17014 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17015 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17016 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17017 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17018 domain causes a syntax error.
17019 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17023 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17024 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17025 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17026 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17027 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17028 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17029 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17030 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17031 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17032 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17033 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17034 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17037 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17038 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17039 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17040 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17041 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17042 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17043 details of Exim's logging.
17046 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17047 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17048 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17049 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17050 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17051 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17052 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17056 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17057 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17058 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17059 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17060 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17064 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17065 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17066 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17067 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17068 details of Exim's logging.
17071 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17072 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17073 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17074 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17075 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17076 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17077 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17078 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17079 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17080 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17081 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17082 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17085 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17086 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17087 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17088 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17089 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17090 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17093 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17094 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17095 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17096 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17097 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17099 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17100 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17101 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17102 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17103 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17105 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17106 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17107 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17108 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17109 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17110 contains the pipe command.
17113 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17114 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17115 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17116 is used in a system filter.
17119 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17120 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17121 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17122 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17123 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17124 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17125 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17126 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17127 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17128 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17130 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17131 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17132 transport option overrides.
17135 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17136 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17137 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17138 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17139 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17140 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17141 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17142 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17143 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17144 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17145 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17146 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17150 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17151 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17152 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17153 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17154 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17155 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17156 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17157 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17158 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17159 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17161 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17162 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17163 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17166 .option timezone main string unset
17167 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17168 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17169 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17170 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17171 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17172 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17176 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17177 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17178 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17179 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17180 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17181 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17184 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17185 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17186 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17187 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17188 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17189 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17190 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17191 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17192 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17193 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17194 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17197 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17198 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17199 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17200 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17201 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17203 The server's private key is also
17204 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17205 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17207 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17208 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17209 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17210 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17212 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17213 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17215 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
17216 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17218 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17219 when a list of more than one file is used.
17221 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17222 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17223 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17224 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17226 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17227 generated for every connection.
17229 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17230 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17231 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17232 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17233 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17236 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17238 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17239 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17240 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17243 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17246 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17247 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17248 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17249 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17250 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17251 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17253 The value must be at least 1024.
17255 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17256 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17257 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17259 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17262 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17263 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17264 larger prime than requested.
17267 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17268 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17269 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17270 to be used by Exim.
17272 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17273 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17274 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17275 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17277 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17278 then it names a file from which DH
17279 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17280 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17281 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17282 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17283 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17284 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17286 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17289 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17290 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17291 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17292 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17294 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17295 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17297 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17298 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17299 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17301 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17302 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17303 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17304 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17305 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17307 The available standard primes are:
17308 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17309 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17310 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17311 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17313 The available additional primes are:
17314 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17316 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17317 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17318 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17319 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17320 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17322 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17323 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17324 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17326 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17327 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17328 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17329 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17330 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17333 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17334 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17335 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17336 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17337 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17338 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17339 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17342 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17343 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17344 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17345 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17347 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17348 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17349 for valid selections.
17351 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17352 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17353 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17355 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17358 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17359 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17360 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17362 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17363 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17364 Certificate Authority.
17366 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17369 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17370 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17371 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17375 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17378 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17379 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17380 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17381 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17385 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17386 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17387 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17388 files which contains the server's private keys.
17389 If this option is unset, or if
17390 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17391 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17392 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17394 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17397 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17398 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17399 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17400 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17401 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17402 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17406 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17407 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17408 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17409 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17410 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17411 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17412 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17413 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17414 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17415 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17416 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17419 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17420 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17421 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17422 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17425 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17426 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17427 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17428 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17430 or the absolute path to
17431 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17432 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17434 The "system" value for the option will use a
17435 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17436 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17437 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17440 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17441 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17443 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17445 either by file or directory
17446 are added to those given by the system default location.
17448 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17449 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17450 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17451 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17452 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17453 use the explicit directory version.
17455 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17457 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17461 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17462 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17463 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17464 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17465 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17466 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17467 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17468 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17470 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17471 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17472 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17473 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17474 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17475 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17476 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17478 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17479 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17480 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17481 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17482 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17483 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17484 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17487 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17491 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17492 .cindex "trusted groups"
17493 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17494 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17495 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17496 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17497 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17498 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17499 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17502 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17503 .cindex "trusted users"
17504 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17505 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17506 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17507 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17508 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17509 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17510 Exim user are trusted.
17512 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17513 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17514 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17515 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17516 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17517 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17518 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17519 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17520 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17523 .option unknown_username main string unset
17524 See &%unknown_login%&.
17526 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17527 .cindex "trusted users"
17528 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17529 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17530 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17531 .cindex "envelope sender"
17532 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17533 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17534 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17535 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17536 is used) is ignored.
17538 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17539 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17541 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17543 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17544 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17545 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17546 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17547 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17548 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17549 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17550 followed by a hyphen
17551 by a setting like this:
17553 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17555 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17556 restriction, you can use
17558 untrusted_set_sender = *
17560 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17561 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17562 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17563 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17564 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17565 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17566 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17567 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17569 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17570 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17571 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17572 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17576 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17577 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17578 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17579 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17580 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17581 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17582 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17583 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17584 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17585 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17587 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17588 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17590 The pattern can be seen by running
17592 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17594 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17595 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17596 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17597 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17598 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17599 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17602 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17603 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17606 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17607 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17608 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17609 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17610 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17611 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17612 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17613 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17616 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17617 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17618 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17619 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17620 .ecindex IIDconfima
17621 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17626 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17627 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17629 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17630 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17631 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17632 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17633 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
17635 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17636 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17637 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17638 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17639 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17643 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17644 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17645 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17646 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17647 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17648 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17649 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17651 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17652 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17653 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17654 routers, and the eventual transport.
17656 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17657 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17658 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17659 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17660 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17662 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17663 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17664 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17665 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17666 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17668 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17669 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17670 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17672 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17674 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17676 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17678 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17679 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17681 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17682 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17683 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17684 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17685 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17686 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17687 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17691 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17693 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17694 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17695 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17696 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17697 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17702 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17703 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17704 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17705 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17706 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17707 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17708 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17709 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17710 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17711 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17714 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17716 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17719 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17721 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17722 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17723 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17724 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17727 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17728 .cindex "case of local parts"
17729 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17730 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17731 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17732 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17733 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17734 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17735 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17738 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17739 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17740 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17741 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17742 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17743 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17744 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17745 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17746 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17748 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17749 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17750 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17751 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17755 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17756 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17757 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17758 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17760 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17761 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17762 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17763 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17764 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17765 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17766 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17767 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17768 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17769 the router is skipped.
17771 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17772 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17773 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17774 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17775 setting to achieve this. For example:
17777 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17779 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17780 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17781 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17785 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17786 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17787 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17788 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17789 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17790 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17791 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17792 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17794 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17795 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17797 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17798 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17800 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17801 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17802 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17804 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17806 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17808 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17811 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17813 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17814 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17818 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17819 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17820 be specified using &%condition%&.
17822 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17823 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17824 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17825 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17826 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17827 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17828 Router rules processing behavior.
17830 This is best illustrated in an example:
17832 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17833 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17835 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17838 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17841 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17842 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17843 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17844 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17845 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17846 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17847 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17848 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17850 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17851 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17852 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17853 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17856 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17857 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17858 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17859 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17860 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17863 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17864 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17865 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17866 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17867 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17868 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17869 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17870 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17871 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17872 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17873 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17874 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17875 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17876 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17880 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17881 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17882 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17883 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17884 transport option of the same name.
17886 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17887 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17888 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17889 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17890 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17891 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17892 the dnssec request bit set.
17893 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17895 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17896 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17897 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17898 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17899 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17900 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17901 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17902 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17903 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17906 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17907 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17908 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17909 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17910 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17911 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17912 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17913 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17917 .option driver routers string unset
17918 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17922 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17923 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17924 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17925 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17926 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17927 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17928 Not effective on redirect routers.
17932 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17933 .cindex "envelope sender"
17934 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17935 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17936 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17937 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17938 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17939 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17940 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17942 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17943 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17944 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17947 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17948 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17949 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17950 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17952 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17953 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17954 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17955 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17961 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17962 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17963 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17964 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17965 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17967 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17968 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17969 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17970 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17971 setting &%return_path%&.
17973 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17974 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17975 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17979 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17980 .cindex "address" "testing"
17981 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17982 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17983 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17984 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17985 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17986 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17987 on for the system alias file.
17988 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17991 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17992 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17993 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17997 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17998 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17999 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18000 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18004 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18005 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18006 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18010 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18011 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18012 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18016 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18017 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18018 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18019 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18020 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18021 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
18022 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18023 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18024 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18026 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18027 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18028 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18029 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18030 transport for further details.
18033 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18034 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18035 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18036 .cindex "transport" "local"
18037 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18038 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18039 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18041 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18042 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18043 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18044 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18045 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18049 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18050 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18051 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18052 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18053 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18054 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18055 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18056 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18057 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18058 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18059 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18060 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18061 &"see"& the added header lines.
18063 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18064 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18065 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18066 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18068 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18069 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18071 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18072 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18074 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18075 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18076 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18077 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18078 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18079 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18080 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18081 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18082 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18083 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18087 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18088 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18089 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18090 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18091 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18092 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18093 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18094 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18095 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18096 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18097 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18098 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18099 &"see"& the original header lines.
18101 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18102 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18103 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18106 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18107 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18109 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18110 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18112 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18113 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18114 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18115 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18117 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18118 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18119 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18123 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18124 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18125 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18126 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18127 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18128 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18129 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18132 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18136 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18138 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18139 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18140 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18141 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18142 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18143 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18145 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18146 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18148 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18149 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18151 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18152 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18154 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18155 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18156 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18157 domain that is being routed.
18159 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18160 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18163 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18164 .cindex "additional groups"
18165 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18166 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18167 .cindex "transport" "local"
18168 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18169 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18170 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18171 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18172 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18176 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18177 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18178 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18179 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18180 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18181 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18184 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18185 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18186 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18187 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18188 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18189 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18190 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18191 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18192 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18194 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18195 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18196 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18197 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18198 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18199 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18200 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18201 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18202 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18203 the relevant transport.
18205 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18206 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18207 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18210 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18211 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18212 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18213 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18214 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18218 local_part_prefix = real-
18220 transport = local_delivery
18222 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18223 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18225 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18226 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18229 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18230 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18231 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18232 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18235 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18236 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18240 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18241 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18242 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18243 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18244 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18245 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18246 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18247 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18248 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18252 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18253 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18257 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18258 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18259 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18260 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18261 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18263 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18264 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18267 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18269 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18270 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18271 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18272 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18273 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18274 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18275 each virtual domain:
18279 local_parts = postmaster
18280 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18284 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18285 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18286 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18287 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18288 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18289 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18290 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18291 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18292 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18293 redirect addresses.
18297 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18298 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18299 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18300 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18301 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18302 delivery to be deferred.
18304 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18305 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18307 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18308 means of the setting
18312 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18313 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18314 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18316 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18317 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18318 controls what happens next.
18321 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18322 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18323 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18324 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18325 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18326 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18327 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18328 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18330 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18331 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18332 applies to all of them.
18336 .option pass_router routers string unset
18337 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18338 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18339 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18340 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18341 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18342 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18343 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18344 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18345 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18346 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18350 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18351 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18352 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18353 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18354 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18355 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18357 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18358 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18359 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18360 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18364 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18365 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18366 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18367 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18368 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18369 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18370 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18372 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18373 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18374 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18375 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18377 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18378 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18379 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18380 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18381 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18384 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18385 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18388 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18389 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18390 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18391 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18392 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18393 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18394 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18395 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18397 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18398 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18399 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18400 operates as follows:
18402 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18403 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18404 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18405 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18408 require_files = mail:/some/file
18409 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18411 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18412 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18414 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18415 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18416 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18417 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18419 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18420 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18421 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18422 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18423 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18425 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18426 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18427 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18428 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18429 check again in that process.
18431 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18432 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18433 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18434 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18435 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18436 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18437 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18439 require_files = +/some/file
18441 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18442 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18443 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18447 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18448 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18449 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18450 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18451 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18452 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18453 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18454 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18457 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18458 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18459 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18460 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18461 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18464 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18465 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18466 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18470 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18471 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18472 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18474 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18475 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18476 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18477 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18478 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18479 cause the router to defer.
18481 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18482 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18484 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18486 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18487 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18489 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18490 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18491 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18492 of these values that is set:
18495 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18497 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18499 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18501 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18504 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18505 router, but not for the transport.
18509 .option self routers string freeze
18510 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18511 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18512 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18513 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18514 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18515 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18517 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18518 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18519 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18520 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18521 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18523 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18524 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18525 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18526 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18527 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18532 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18534 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18535 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18536 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18537 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18539 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18540 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18541 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18546 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18547 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18548 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18549 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18550 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18551 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18557 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18558 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18559 be passed to the next router.
18562 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18565 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18566 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18567 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18568 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18569 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18570 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18575 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18576 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18577 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18578 address matches something on the list.
18579 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18582 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18583 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18584 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18585 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18586 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18587 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18588 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18592 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18593 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18594 .cindex "packet radio"
18595 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18596 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18597 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18598 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18599 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18600 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18601 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18602 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18604 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18605 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18606 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18607 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18608 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18609 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18610 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18611 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18612 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18613 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18615 translate_ip_address = \
18616 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18619 The file would contain lines like
18621 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18622 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18624 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18629 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18630 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18631 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18632 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18633 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18634 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18635 delivery is deferred.
18637 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18638 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18639 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18643 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18644 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18645 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18646 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18647 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18648 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18649 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18650 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18651 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18652 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18653 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18659 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18660 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18661 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18662 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18663 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18664 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18665 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18666 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18667 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18668 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18670 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18671 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18672 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18673 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18674 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18676 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18682 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18683 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18684 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18685 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18686 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18687 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18688 delivery to be deferred.
18690 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18691 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18692 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18693 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18694 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18695 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18697 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18698 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18699 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18700 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18701 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18702 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18703 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18704 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18706 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18707 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18708 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18709 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18710 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18711 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18712 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18713 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18714 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18715 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18717 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18718 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18719 subsequent routers.
18722 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18723 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18724 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18725 .cindex "transport" "local"
18726 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18727 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18728 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18729 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18730 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18731 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18732 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18733 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18734 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18735 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18736 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18737 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18741 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18742 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18743 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18746 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18747 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18749 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18750 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18751 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18752 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18753 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18754 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18755 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18757 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18758 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18759 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18763 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18764 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18766 delivering in cutthrough mode
18767 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18768 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18770 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18773 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18774 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18775 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18776 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18778 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18779 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18780 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18790 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18791 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18792 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18793 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18794 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18795 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18796 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18797 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18798 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18802 domains = mydomain.example
18804 transport = local_delivery
18806 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18807 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18808 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18809 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18816 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18817 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18819 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18820 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18821 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18822 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18823 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18824 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18826 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18827 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18828 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18829 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18832 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18833 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18834 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18836 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18838 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18839 generic option, the router declines.
18841 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18842 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18843 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18845 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18846 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18847 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18848 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18849 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18850 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18853 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18854 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18855 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18856 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18857 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18858 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18860 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18861 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18862 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18863 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18864 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18865 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18866 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18867 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18868 case routing fails.
18871 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18872 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18873 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18874 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18875 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18877 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18878 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18880 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18882 The domain does not exist in DNS
18884 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18885 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18886 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18888 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18890 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18892 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18893 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18895 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18896 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18898 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18899 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18901 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18902 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18908 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18909 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18910 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18912 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18913 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18914 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18915 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18916 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18917 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18918 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18921 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18922 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18923 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18924 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18925 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18926 required. For example,
18930 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18931 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18932 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18933 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18934 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18937 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18938 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18939 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18940 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18941 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18942 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18944 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18945 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18946 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18947 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18948 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18949 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18950 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18951 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18953 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18954 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18959 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18960 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18961 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18962 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18963 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18964 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18965 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18966 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18971 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
18972 .cindex IPv6 disabling
18973 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
18974 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18975 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18976 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18977 only A records are used.
18979 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
18980 .cindex IPv4 preference
18981 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
18982 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18983 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18984 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18985 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
18988 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18989 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18990 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18991 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18992 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18993 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18994 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18997 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18999 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19000 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19001 the address record.
19004 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19005 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19006 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19007 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19012 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19013 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19014 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19015 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19016 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19017 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19018 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19019 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19020 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19025 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19026 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19027 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19028 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19029 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19030 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19031 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19032 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19033 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19034 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19035 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19037 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19038 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19041 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19042 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19043 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19044 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19045 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19049 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19050 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19051 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19052 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19053 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19054 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19055 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19056 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19058 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19059 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19060 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19061 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19062 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19063 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19064 without processing them independently,
19065 provided the following conditions are met:
19068 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19069 &%headers_remove%&.
19071 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19078 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19079 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19080 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19081 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19082 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19083 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19084 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19085 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19086 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19087 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19089 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19090 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19095 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19096 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19097 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19098 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19103 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19104 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19105 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19106 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19109 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19111 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19112 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19113 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19114 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19115 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19116 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19119 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19120 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19121 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19122 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19123 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19125 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19126 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19127 such as that implied by
19131 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19132 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19133 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19134 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19144 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19147 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19148 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19149 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19150 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19151 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19152 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19153 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19154 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19155 router handles the address
19159 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19160 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19161 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19163 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19165 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19166 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19168 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19169 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19170 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19171 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19173 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19174 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19175 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19176 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19183 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19184 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19185 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19186 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19187 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19188 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19191 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19193 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19195 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19196 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19197 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19198 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19199 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19200 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19201 must not be specified for it.
19203 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19204 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19205 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19206 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19207 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19208 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19209 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19212 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19213 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19214 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19215 delivery to the address is deferred.
19218 .option port iplookup integer 0
19219 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19220 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19224 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19225 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19226 protocols is to be used.
19229 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19230 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19233 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19235 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19236 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19239 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19240 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19241 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19242 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19243 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19244 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19245 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19246 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19249 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19250 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19251 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19252 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19253 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19254 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19255 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19256 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19257 following could be used:
19259 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19260 reroute = $local_part@$1
19263 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19264 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19265 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19266 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19274 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19275 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19276 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19277 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19278 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19279 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19280 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19281 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19282 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19283 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19285 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19286 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19287 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19288 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19289 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19290 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19291 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19294 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19295 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19296 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19297 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19298 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19299 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19300 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19303 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19304 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19305 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19306 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19307 below, following the list of private options.
19310 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19312 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19313 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19315 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19316 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19318 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19319 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19320 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19321 of the following values:
19330 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19331 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19332 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19335 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19336 router only if &%more%& is true.
19338 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19339 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19340 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19341 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19343 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19344 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19345 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19348 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19349 .cindex "randomized host list"
19350 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19351 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19352 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19353 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19354 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19355 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19356 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19357 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19359 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19360 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19361 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19362 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19364 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19366 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19367 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19368 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19369 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19370 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19373 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19374 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19375 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19378 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19380 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19381 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19385 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19386 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19387 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19388 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19391 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19392 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19393 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19394 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19395 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19396 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19397 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19398 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19400 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19401 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19402 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19403 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19404 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19405 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19406 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19407 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19412 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19413 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19414 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19415 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19416 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19417 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19419 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19421 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19425 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19426 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19428 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19429 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19430 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19431 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19432 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19433 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19434 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19435 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19436 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19437 in a &%route_list%&).
19439 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19440 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19441 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19442 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19446 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19447 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19448 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19449 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19450 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19451 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19452 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19455 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19456 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19458 This data can be accessed by setting
19460 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19462 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19463 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19464 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19465 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19466 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19471 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19472 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19473 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19474 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19475 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19476 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19477 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19479 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19480 variables are set during its expansion:
19483 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19484 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19485 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19487 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19490 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19492 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19495 .vindex "&$value$&"
19496 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19497 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19499 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19503 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19504 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19508 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19509 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19510 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19511 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19512 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19513 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19516 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19517 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19518 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19520 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19521 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19524 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19525 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19526 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19527 number follows. For example:
19529 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19533 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19534 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19535 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19536 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19537 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19540 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19541 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19542 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19543 records in the DNS. For example:
19545 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19547 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19550 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19552 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19553 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19554 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19555 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19556 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19557 happens is controlled by the
19558 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19559 &%self%& option of the router.
19561 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19562 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19563 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19564 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19565 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19566 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19567 defined by MX preferences.
19569 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19570 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19571 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19573 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19574 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19575 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19576 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19578 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19579 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19582 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19583 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19584 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19586 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19587 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19591 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19592 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19593 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19594 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19595 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19596 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19597 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19600 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19601 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19603 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19604 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19606 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19607 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19608 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19610 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19611 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19612 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19615 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19617 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19623 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19624 domain2 host4:host5
19626 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19627 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19628 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19629 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19632 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19633 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19634 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19635 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19638 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19639 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19644 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19645 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19648 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19649 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19653 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19654 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19655 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19658 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19659 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19660 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19661 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19663 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19665 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19666 your first router something like this:
19669 driver = manualroute
19670 domains = !+local_domains
19671 transport = remote_smtp
19672 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19674 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19675 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19676 they are tried in order
19677 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19678 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19681 driver = manualroute
19682 transport = remote_smtp
19683 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19685 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19686 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19687 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19688 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19689 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19690 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19691 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19692 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19695 .cindex "mail hub example"
19696 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19697 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19698 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19699 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19700 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19701 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19702 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19703 lookup is easier to manage.
19705 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19706 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19710 driver = manualroute
19711 transport = remote_smtp
19712 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19714 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19715 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19716 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19717 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19718 domain can be used to find the host:
19721 driver = manualroute
19722 transport = remote_smtp
19723 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19725 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19726 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19727 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19731 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19732 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19733 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19734 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19735 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19736 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19739 driver = manualroute
19740 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19741 route_list = saved.domain.example
19743 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19744 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19745 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19748 driver = manualroute
19750 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19751 *.saved.domain2.example \
19752 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19755 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19757 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19758 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19759 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19760 the address if the lookup fails.
19763 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19764 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19765 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19766 one way it can be done:
19772 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19773 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19774 return_fail_output = true
19779 driver = manualroute
19781 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19783 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19785 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19787 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19788 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19789 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19791 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19792 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19801 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19802 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19804 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19805 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19806 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19807 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19808 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19809 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19810 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19811 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19812 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19813 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19815 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19817 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19818 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19819 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19820 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19821 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19824 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19825 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19826 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19827 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19828 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19829 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19832 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19833 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19834 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19835 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19836 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19837 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19838 not set, a value for the gid also.
19840 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19841 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19842 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19843 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19844 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19845 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19849 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19850 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19851 before running the command.
19854 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19855 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19856 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19860 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19861 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19862 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19863 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19864 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19867 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19870 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19871 &%no_more%& is set.
19873 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19874 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19875 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19876 included in the SMTP response.
19878 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19879 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19880 included in any SMTP response.
19882 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19884 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19885 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19887 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19888 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19889 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19892 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19893 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19896 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19897 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19899 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19900 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19901 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19902 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19904 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19905 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19906 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19907 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19908 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19910 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19911 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19912 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19913 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19914 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19916 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19917 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19918 variable. For example, this return line
19920 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19922 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19923 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19924 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19925 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19930 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19931 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19933 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19934 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19935 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19936 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19937 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19938 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19939 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19940 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19941 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19942 redirected in several different ways:
19945 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19948 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19950 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19952 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19954 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19956 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19958 It can be discarded.
19961 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19962 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19963 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19964 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19966 If success DSNs have been requested
19967 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19968 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19969 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19973 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19974 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19975 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19976 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19977 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19978 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19982 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19984 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19985 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19986 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19987 cause delivery to be deferred.
19989 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19990 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19995 file = $home/.forward
19998 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19999 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20000 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20001 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20006 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20007 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20008 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20009 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20012 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20013 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20014 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20015 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20017 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20018 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20019 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20020 saves some resources.
20028 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20029 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20030 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20031 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20032 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20035 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20036 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20037 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20038 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20039 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20040 document is intended for use by end users.
20042 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20043 described in the next section.
20046 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20047 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20048 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20049 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20050 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20054 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20055 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20056 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20057 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20058 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20059 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20060 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20061 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20062 commas or newlines.
20063 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20066 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20067 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20068 next newline character is ignored.
20070 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20071 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20072 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20073 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20076 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20077 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20078 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20079 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20080 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20081 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20084 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20088 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20089 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20090 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20091 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20092 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20093 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20094 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20095 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20096 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20097 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20098 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20100 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20101 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20102 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20103 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20104 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20106 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20108 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20109 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20110 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20111 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20112 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20115 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20116 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20117 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20118 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20119 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20121 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20122 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20127 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20128 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20131 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20133 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20134 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20135 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20136 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20137 should really contain
20139 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20141 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20142 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20143 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20147 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20148 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20149 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20152 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20153 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20154 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20155 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20156 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20157 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20158 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20160 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20161 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20162 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20163 in double quotes, for example:
20165 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20167 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20168 quote just the command. An item such as
20170 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20172 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20174 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20175 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20176 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20177 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20178 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20179 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20180 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20181 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20182 an &%accept%& router.
20185 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20186 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20187 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20188 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20190 /home/world/minbari
20192 is treated as a file name, but
20194 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20196 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20197 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20198 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20199 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20201 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20202 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20204 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20205 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20206 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20207 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20210 .cindex "included address list"
20211 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20212 If an item is of the form
20214 :include:<path name>
20216 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20217 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20218 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20219 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20220 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20221 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20223 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20225 It must be given as
20227 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20230 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20231 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20232 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20233 .cindex "black hole"
20234 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20235 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20236 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20237 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20241 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20242 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20243 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20245 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20246 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20247 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20248 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20252 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20253 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20254 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20255 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20256 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20257 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20258 redirection items of the form
20263 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20264 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20265 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20266 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20268 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20270 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20272 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20273 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20275 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20276 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20277 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20279 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20280 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20281 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20282 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20283 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20284 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20285 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20286 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20287 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20290 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20291 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20292 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20293 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20295 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20296 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20297 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20298 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20299 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20301 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20302 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20303 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20304 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20305 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20309 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20310 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20311 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20312 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20313 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20314 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20315 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20319 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20320 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20321 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20322 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20323 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20324 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20325 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20326 aliasing scheme of the type
20328 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20332 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20333 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20334 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20337 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20338 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20340 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20341 the pipes are distinct.
20345 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20346 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20347 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20348 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20349 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20350 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20351 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20352 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20353 can be used to avoid this.
20356 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20357 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20358 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20359 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20360 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20361 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20362 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20366 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20368 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20369 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20372 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20373 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20374 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20377 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20378 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20379 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20380 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20383 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20384 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20385 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20386 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20387 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20388 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20389 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20391 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20392 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20395 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20396 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20397 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20398 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20399 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20403 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20404 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20405 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20406 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20407 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20408 let ordinary users do.
20412 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20413 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20414 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20415 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20416 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20417 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20419 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20420 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20421 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20422 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20423 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20424 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20426 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20428 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20429 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20430 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20431 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20432 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20433 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20434 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20435 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20438 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20439 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20440 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20441 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20442 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20443 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20444 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20445 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20449 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20450 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20451 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20452 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20453 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20454 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20457 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20458 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20459 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20460 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20461 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20462 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20464 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20465 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20466 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20468 data = #Exim filter\n\
20469 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20471 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20472 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20473 choice into a newline.
20476 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20477 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20478 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20479 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20480 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20483 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20484 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20485 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20486 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20487 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20488 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20489 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20490 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20492 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20493 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20494 runs a check on the containing directory,
20495 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20496 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20497 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20498 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20499 not, the router declines.
20502 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20503 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20504 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20505 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20506 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20507 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20508 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20511 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20512 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20513 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20514 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20515 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20518 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20519 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20520 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20521 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20525 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20526 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20527 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20528 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20529 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20534 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20535 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20536 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20537 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20538 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20539 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20540 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20541 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20542 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20543 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20544 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20547 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20548 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20549 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20550 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20551 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20554 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20555 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20556 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20557 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20558 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20559 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20561 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20562 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20563 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20564 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20565 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20566 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20567 &_.forward_& files).
20570 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20571 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20572 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20573 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20574 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20577 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20578 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20579 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20580 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20581 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20582 of the embedded Perl support.
20585 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20586 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20587 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20588 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20589 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20592 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20593 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20594 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20595 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20596 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20599 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20600 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20601 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20602 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20603 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20604 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20605 &%one_time%& is set.
20608 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20609 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20610 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20611 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20612 to make use of &%run%& items.
20615 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20616 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20617 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20618 If this option is true, items of the form
20620 :include:<path name>
20622 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20625 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20626 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20627 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20628 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20629 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20630 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20631 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20634 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20635 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20636 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20637 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20638 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20641 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20642 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20643 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20644 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20645 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20650 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20651 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20652 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20653 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20654 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20655 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20656 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20659 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20661 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20662 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20663 file did not exist.
20666 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20668 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20669 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20670 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20672 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20673 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20674 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20675 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20676 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20677 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20678 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20679 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20683 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20684 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20685 redirection list must start with this directory.
20688 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20689 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20690 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20693 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20694 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20695 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20696 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20697 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20698 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20699 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20700 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20701 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20702 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20703 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20704 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20705 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20706 before they subscribed.
20708 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20709 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20710 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20711 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20714 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20715 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20716 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20717 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20719 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20720 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20721 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20723 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20726 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20727 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20728 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20729 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20730 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20734 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20735 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20736 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20737 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20738 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20739 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20740 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20741 See &%check_owner%& above.
20744 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20745 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20746 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20747 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20750 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20751 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20752 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20753 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20754 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20755 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20756 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20759 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20760 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20761 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20762 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20763 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20764 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20765 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20766 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20768 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20769 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20770 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20773 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20774 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20775 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20776 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20777 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20778 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20779 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20780 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20781 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20782 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20785 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20786 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20787 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20788 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20789 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20790 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20793 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20794 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20795 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20796 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20797 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20798 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20801 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20802 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20803 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20804 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20805 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20808 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20809 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20810 :subaddress part of an address.
20812 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20813 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20814 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20815 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20818 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20819 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20820 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20821 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20822 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20823 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20824 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20828 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20829 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20830 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20831 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20832 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20833 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20834 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20835 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20836 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20837 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20838 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20839 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20840 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20841 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20842 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20843 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20845 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20846 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20847 the following routers.
20849 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20850 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20851 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20852 so it is passed to the following routers.
20854 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20855 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20856 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20857 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20859 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20860 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20861 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20862 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20868 file = $home/.forward
20869 file_transport = address_file
20870 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20871 reply_transport = address_reply
20874 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20875 syntax_errors_text = \
20876 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20877 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20878 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20879 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20880 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20881 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20882 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20883 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20884 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20885 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20887 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20888 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20889 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20894 local_part_prefix = real-
20895 transport = local_delivery
20897 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20898 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20900 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20901 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20905 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20906 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20909 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20910 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20911 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20912 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20922 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20923 "Environment for local transports"
20924 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20925 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20926 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20927 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20928 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20929 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20930 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20932 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20933 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20934 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20935 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20937 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20938 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20939 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20940 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20941 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20945 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20946 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20947 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20948 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20949 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20950 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20951 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20954 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20955 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20959 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20961 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20962 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20963 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20964 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20969 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20970 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20971 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20972 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20973 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20974 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20975 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20976 group (set by the transport). For example:
20979 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20983 transport = group_delivery
20986 # This transport overrides the group
20988 driver = appendfile
20989 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20992 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20993 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20994 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20997 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20998 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20999 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21000 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21001 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21002 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21004 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21005 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21006 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21007 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21008 original gid is also used.
21010 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21011 following that is set is used:
21014 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21016 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21018 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21019 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21021 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21023 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21024 the uid is the creator's uid;
21026 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21029 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21030 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21031 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21032 The first of the following that is set is used:
21035 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21037 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21039 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21041 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21046 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21047 &%never_users%& list.
21053 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21054 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21055 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21056 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21057 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21058 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21059 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21060 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21061 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21062 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21065 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21067 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21069 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21071 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21074 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21077 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21079 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21083 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21084 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21085 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21089 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21090 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21091 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21092 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21093 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21094 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21095 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21096 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21097 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21098 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21099 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21100 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21101 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21102 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21113 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21114 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21115 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21116 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21117 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21120 .option body_only transports boolean false
21121 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21122 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21123 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21124 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21125 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21126 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21127 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21128 automatically suppress them.
21131 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21132 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21133 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21134 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21135 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21136 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21139 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21140 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21141 deliveries by the transport or for any
21142 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21143 what you are doing.
21146 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21147 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21148 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21149 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21151 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21152 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21153 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21154 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21155 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21156 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21158 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21159 transport and the router that called it.
21161 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21162 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21163 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21164 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21165 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21166 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21167 safely be resent to other recipients.
21170 .option driver transports string unset
21171 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21172 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21175 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21176 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21177 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21178 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21179 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21180 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21181 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21182 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21183 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21184 resent to other recipients.
21187 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21189 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21190 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21193 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21194 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21195 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21196 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21197 &%user%& (see below).
21200 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21201 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21202 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21203 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21204 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21205 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21206 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21207 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21208 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21209 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21210 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21212 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21213 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21216 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21217 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21218 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21219 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21220 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21221 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21222 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21223 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21226 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21227 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21228 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21229 This option specifies a list of header names,
21230 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21231 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21232 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21234 Each list item is separately expanded.
21235 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21236 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21237 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21239 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21240 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21242 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21243 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21244 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21248 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21249 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21250 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21251 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21252 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21253 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21254 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21255 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21258 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21261 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21262 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21263 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21264 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21265 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21266 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21267 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21268 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21269 change envelope recipients at this time.
21272 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21273 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21275 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21276 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21277 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21278 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21279 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21280 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21281 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21285 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21286 .cindex "additional groups"
21287 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21288 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21289 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21290 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21291 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21294 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21295 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21296 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21297 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21298 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21299 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21300 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21301 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21303 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21304 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21305 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21306 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21307 Obviously there is scope for
21308 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21309 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21311 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21312 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21313 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21314 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21315 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21318 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21319 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21320 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21321 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21322 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21323 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21324 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21325 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21326 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21327 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21328 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21329 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21330 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21335 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21336 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21337 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21338 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21339 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21340 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21341 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21342 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21345 local_part_prefix = *-
21347 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21350 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21352 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21353 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21354 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21355 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21356 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21359 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21360 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21361 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21362 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21363 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21364 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21365 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21366 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21367 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21369 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21370 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21371 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21372 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21374 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21375 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21376 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21379 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21380 .cindex "envelope sender"
21381 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21382 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21383 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21384 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21385 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21386 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21387 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21388 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21389 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21391 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21392 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21394 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21395 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21396 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21397 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21398 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21399 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21400 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21402 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21403 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21404 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21405 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21406 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21410 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21411 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21412 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21413 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21414 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21415 have easy access to it.
21417 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21418 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21419 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21420 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21421 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21425 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21426 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21429 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21430 .cindex "shadow transport"
21431 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21432 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21433 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21435 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21436 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21437 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21438 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21439 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21440 cause a log line to be written.
21442 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21443 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21444 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21445 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21446 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21449 ST=<shadow transport name>
21451 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21452 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21453 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21454 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21455 headers that some sites insist on.
21458 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21459 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21460 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21461 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21462 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21463 individual users or via a system filter.
21464 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21466 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21467 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21468 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21469 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21470 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21472 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21473 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21474 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21475 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21476 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21477 &(pipe)& transports.
21479 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21480 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21481 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21482 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21483 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21485 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21486 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21487 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21488 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21490 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21491 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21492 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21493 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21494 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21495 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21497 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21498 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21499 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21500 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21501 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21502 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21503 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21504 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21506 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21507 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21508 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21509 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21510 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21511 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21512 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21513 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21514 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21515 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21518 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21519 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21520 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21521 which the message is being sent. For example:
21523 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21524 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21527 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21528 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21529 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21531 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21532 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21533 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21536 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21538 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21539 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21540 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21541 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21542 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21543 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21545 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21546 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21547 arguments. Consider this example:
21549 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21550 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21552 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21553 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21555 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21556 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21560 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21561 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21562 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21563 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21564 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21565 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21566 bounced from a transport filter.
21568 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21569 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21570 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21573 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21574 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21575 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21576 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21577 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21578 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21579 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21580 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21581 becomes a temporary error.
21584 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21585 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21586 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21587 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21588 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21589 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21590 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21593 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21594 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21595 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21597 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21598 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21599 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21600 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21602 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21603 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21604 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21611 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21614 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21616 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21617 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21618 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21619 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21620 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21621 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21622 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21624 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21625 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21626 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21627 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21628 local transport, for example:
21631 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21632 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21633 recipients saves space.
21635 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21636 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21638 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21639 to a scanner program or
21640 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21644 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21645 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21646 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21648 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21649 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21650 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21651 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21652 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21653 to certain conditions:
21656 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21657 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21658 batching is possible.
21660 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21661 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21662 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21664 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21665 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21666 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21667 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21668 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21671 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21672 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21673 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21677 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21678 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21679 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21680 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21681 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21682 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21683 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21686 escape_string = ".."
21688 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21689 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21690 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21692 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21693 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21694 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21695 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21696 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21697 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21699 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21700 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21701 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21702 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21703 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21704 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21705 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21706 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21707 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21715 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21716 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21717 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21718 .cindex "directory creation"
21719 .cindex "creating directories"
21720 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21721 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21722 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21723 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21724 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21725 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21726 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21727 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21728 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21729 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21731 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21732 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21733 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21736 .cindex "quota" "system"
21737 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21738 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21739 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21741 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21742 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21743 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21744 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21746 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21747 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21750 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21751 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21752 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21753 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21758 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21759 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21760 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21761 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21762 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21764 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21765 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21766 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21767 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21768 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21769 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21770 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21771 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21772 operation. There are two cases:
21775 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21776 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21777 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21778 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21779 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21780 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21781 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21783 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21784 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21785 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21789 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21790 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21791 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21792 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21797 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21799 require "fileinto";
21800 fileinto "folder23";
21802 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21803 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21804 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21805 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21806 way of handling this requirement:
21808 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21809 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21810 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21812 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21816 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21817 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21818 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21820 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21821 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21822 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21823 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21824 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21825 path to the transport.
21827 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21828 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21833 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21834 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21838 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21839 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21840 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21841 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21842 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21843 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21844 delivery is deferred.
21847 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21848 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21849 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21850 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21851 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21852 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21853 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21854 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21857 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21858 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21859 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21860 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21864 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21865 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21868 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21869 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21870 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21871 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21872 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21875 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21876 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21877 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21878 process is running.
21881 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21882 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21883 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21884 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21885 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21886 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21887 contains is significant.
21889 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21890 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21891 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21892 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21893 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21895 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21896 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21897 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21898 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21899 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21900 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21902 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21903 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21904 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21905 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21907 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21908 .cindex "directory creation"
21909 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21910 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21911 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21913 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21914 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21915 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21916 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21917 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21921 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21922 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21923 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21924 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21925 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21928 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21929 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21930 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21931 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21932 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21933 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21934 &%file_must_exist%&.
21937 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21938 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21939 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21940 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21942 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21943 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21944 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21945 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21946 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21949 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21951 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21952 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21953 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21954 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21956 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21958 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21959 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21963 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21964 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21965 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21968 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21969 See &%check_string%& above.
21972 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21973 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21974 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21975 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21976 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21977 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21980 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21981 .cindex "locking files"
21982 .cindex "lock files"
21983 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21984 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21986 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21987 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21990 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21991 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21994 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21995 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21996 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21997 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21998 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21999 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22003 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22004 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22005 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22006 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22007 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22008 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22009 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22010 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22011 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22014 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22015 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22017 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22018 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22019 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22020 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22021 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22022 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22023 delivery is deferred.
22026 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22027 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22028 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22029 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22032 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22033 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22034 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22035 .cindex "locking files"
22036 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22037 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22038 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22039 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22040 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22041 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22042 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22043 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22045 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22046 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22047 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22048 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22050 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22051 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22054 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22056 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22057 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22058 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22060 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22061 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22063 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22066 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22067 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22068 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22069 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22072 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22073 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22074 for details of locking.
22077 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22078 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22079 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22082 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22083 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22084 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22087 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22088 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22089 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22090 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22091 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22094 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22095 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22096 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22097 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22098 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22099 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22100 external source that maintains the data.
22103 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22104 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22105 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22106 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22107 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22108 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22109 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22110 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22114 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22115 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22116 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22117 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22118 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22119 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22120 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22121 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22122 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22123 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22126 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22127 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22128 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22129 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22130 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22131 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22132 calculation. The default value is:
22134 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22136 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22137 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22139 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22141 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22143 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22144 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22145 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22146 directly into that directory.
22149 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22150 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22151 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22154 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22155 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22156 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22159 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22160 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22161 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22162 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22163 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22164 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22165 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22166 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22168 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22169 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22170 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22171 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22172 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22173 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22174 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22175 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22176 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22177 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22180 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22181 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22182 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22183 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22184 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22185 below for further details.
22188 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22189 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22190 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22193 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22194 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22195 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22198 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22199 .cindex "locking files"
22200 .cindex "file" "locking"
22201 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22202 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22203 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22204 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22205 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22206 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22207 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22209 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22210 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22211 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22218 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22219 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22220 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22221 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22222 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22223 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22224 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22225 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22227 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22228 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22229 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22230 append messages to it.
22233 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22234 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22235 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22236 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22237 in which case it is:
22239 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22240 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22242 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22243 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22245 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22246 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22247 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22248 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22253 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22254 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22256 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22257 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22258 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22259 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22260 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22261 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22262 value, and this option is ignored.
22265 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22266 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22267 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22268 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22269 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22272 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22273 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22274 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22275 on users about incoming mail.
22278 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22279 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22280 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22281 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22282 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22283 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22284 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22285 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22286 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22288 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22289 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22290 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22292 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22293 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22294 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22295 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22296 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22297 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22299 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22300 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22301 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22302 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22303 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22306 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22307 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22309 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22311 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22312 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22313 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22314 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22315 system quota failures.
22317 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22318 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22319 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22320 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22321 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22322 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22323 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22324 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22325 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22326 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22329 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22330 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22331 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22332 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22333 delivery directory.
22336 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22337 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22338 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22339 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22340 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22343 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22344 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22346 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22347 See &%quota%& above.
22350 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22351 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22352 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22353 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22354 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22355 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22356 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22358 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22359 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22360 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22361 the file length to the file name. For example:
22363 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22364 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22366 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22367 number of lines in the message.
22369 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22370 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22371 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22373 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22376 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22377 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22378 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22380 quota_warn_message = "\
22381 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22382 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22383 This message is automatically created \
22384 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22385 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22386 a warning threshold that is\n\
22387 set by the system administrator.\n"
22391 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22392 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22393 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22394 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22395 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22396 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22397 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22398 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22399 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22403 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22405 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22406 percent sign is ignored.
22408 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22409 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22410 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22411 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22412 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22413 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22415 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22417 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22418 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22421 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22422 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22426 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22427 .cindex "envelope sender"
22428 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22429 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22430 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22431 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22432 for details of batch SMTP.
22435 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22436 .cindex "carriage return"
22438 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22439 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22440 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22441 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22443 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22444 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22445 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22446 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22447 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22448 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22451 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22452 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22453 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22454 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22455 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22456 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22459 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22460 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22461 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22462 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22463 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22465 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22466 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22467 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22468 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22470 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22471 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22472 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22473 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22474 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22477 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22478 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22481 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22482 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22483 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22484 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22485 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22486 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22487 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22489 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22490 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22491 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22492 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22495 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22496 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22497 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22500 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22501 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22502 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22503 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22504 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22505 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22506 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22507 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22508 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22510 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22511 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22512 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22513 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22518 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22519 .cindex "appending to a file"
22520 .cindex "file" "appending"
22521 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22524 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22528 .cindex "directory creation"
22529 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22530 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22531 &%directory_mode%& option.
22534 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22535 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22539 .cindex "file" "locking"
22540 .cindex "locking files"
22541 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22542 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22543 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22546 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22547 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22548 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22550 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22552 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22553 Unlink the hitching post name.
22555 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22556 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22557 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22558 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22560 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22561 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22562 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22563 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22564 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22565 it before trying again.
22569 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22570 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22571 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22574 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22575 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22576 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22577 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22578 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22579 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22580 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22581 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22582 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22586 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22587 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22588 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22589 delivery is deferred.
22592 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22593 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22594 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22598 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22599 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22600 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22603 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22604 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22605 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22608 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22609 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22610 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22611 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22612 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22613 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22614 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22615 that prevents link following.
22618 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22619 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22620 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22621 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22622 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22625 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22628 .cindex "file" "locking"
22629 .cindex "locking files"
22630 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22631 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22632 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22633 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22634 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22636 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22638 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22639 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22640 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22642 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22643 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22644 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22646 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22647 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22648 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22649 delivery is deferred.
22651 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22652 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22653 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22654 immediately. It retries up to
22656 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22658 times (rounded up).
22661 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22662 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22665 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22666 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22667 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22668 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22669 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22670 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22671 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22672 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22673 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22674 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22676 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22677 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22678 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22679 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22680 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22681 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22682 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22684 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22685 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22686 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22687 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22690 .cindex "maildir format"
22691 .cindex "mailstore format"
22692 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22693 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22694 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22695 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22696 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22698 .cindex "directory creation"
22699 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22700 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22701 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22702 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22703 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22704 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22709 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22710 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22711 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22712 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22713 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22714 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22715 &_new_& subdirectory.
22717 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22718 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22719 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22720 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22721 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22722 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22723 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22725 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22726 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22727 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22728 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22729 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22730 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22731 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22732 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22734 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22735 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22736 folders. Consider this example:
22738 maildir_format = true
22739 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22740 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22741 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22742 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22744 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22745 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22746 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22747 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22748 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22749 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22751 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22752 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22753 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22754 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22755 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22757 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22758 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22759 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22761 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22762 .cindex "maildir++"
22763 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22764 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22765 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22766 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22767 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22768 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22769 amount of space used.
22771 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22772 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22773 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22774 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22775 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22776 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22781 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22782 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22783 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22784 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22785 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22786 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22789 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22790 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22791 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22792 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22793 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22794 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22795 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22796 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22797 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22798 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22799 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22800 backwards compatibility).
22802 For one common implementation, you might set:
22804 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22806 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22808 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22809 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22810 &[stat()]& each message file.
22813 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22814 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22815 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22816 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22817 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22818 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22819 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22820 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22821 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22823 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22824 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22825 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22826 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22827 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22828 need to know the quota.
22830 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22831 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22833 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22834 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22835 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22839 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22840 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22841 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22842 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22843 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22844 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22845 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22846 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22848 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22849 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22850 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22851 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22852 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22853 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22855 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22856 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22857 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22858 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22859 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22860 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22862 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22863 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22864 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22865 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22868 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22869 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22870 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22871 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22872 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22874 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22876 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22877 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22878 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22879 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22880 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22890 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22891 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22892 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22893 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22894 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22895 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22896 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22897 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22899 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22900 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22901 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22902 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22903 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22906 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22907 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22908 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22909 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22910 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22912 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22913 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22914 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22915 transport is run as a consequence of a
22917 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22918 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22919 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22920 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22921 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22922 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22924 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22925 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22926 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22927 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22929 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22930 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22931 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22932 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22933 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22934 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22935 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22937 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22938 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22939 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22940 the transport defers.
22941 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22942 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22944 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22945 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22946 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22947 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22949 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22950 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22951 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22952 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22953 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22954 problems. They are just discarded.
22958 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22959 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22961 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22962 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22963 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22966 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22967 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22968 when the message is specified by the transport.
22971 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22972 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22973 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22974 string comes first.
22977 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22978 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22979 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22982 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22983 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22984 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22987 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22988 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22989 specified by the transport.
22992 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22993 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22994 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22995 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22998 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22999 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23000 the message is specified by the transport.
23003 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23004 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23008 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23009 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23010 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23011 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23012 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23016 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23017 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23018 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23019 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23021 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23022 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
23023 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23024 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23025 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23026 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23027 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23030 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23031 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23032 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23033 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23034 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23036 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23037 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23038 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23039 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23040 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23041 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23044 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23045 See &%once%& above.
23048 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23049 See &%once%& above.
23050 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23053 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23054 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23055 specified by the transport.
23058 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23059 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23060 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23061 configuration option.
23064 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23065 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23066 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23067 automatic responses. For example:
23069 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23071 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23072 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23073 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23074 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23079 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23080 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23081 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23082 the text comes first.
23085 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23086 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23087 when the message is specified by the transport.
23088 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23089 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23095 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23097 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23098 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23099 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23100 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23101 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23102 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23104 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23105 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23106 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23107 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23108 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23109 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23113 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23114 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23115 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23118 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23119 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23122 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23123 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23124 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23125 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23126 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23129 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23130 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23131 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23132 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23133 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23134 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23137 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23138 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23139 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23140 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23141 in its response to the LHLO command.
23143 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23144 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23145 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23146 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23149 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23150 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23151 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23152 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23157 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23161 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23162 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23169 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23170 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23171 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23172 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23173 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23174 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23175 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23176 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23180 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23181 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23182 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23183 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23184 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23186 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23187 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23188 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23189 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23190 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23191 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23192 that are routed to the transport.
23194 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23195 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23196 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23197 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23198 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23199 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23200 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23204 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23205 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23206 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23208 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23209 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23210 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23211 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23212 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23213 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23214 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23217 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23218 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23219 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23220 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23221 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23222 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23223 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23228 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23229 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23230 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23231 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23232 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23233 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23234 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23235 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23236 &"local delivery failed"&.
23238 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23239 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23240 will be sent as normal.
23242 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23243 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23244 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23245 apply in this case.
23247 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23248 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23249 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23250 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23252 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23253 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23254 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23255 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23256 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23257 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23258 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23263 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23264 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23265 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23266 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23267 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23270 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23271 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23272 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23273 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23275 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23276 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23277 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23278 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23279 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23281 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23283 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23284 arguments. You have to write
23286 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23288 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23289 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23290 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23291 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23292 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23293 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23296 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23299 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23300 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23301 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23302 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23303 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23304 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23305 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23306 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23307 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23308 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23310 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23311 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23312 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23313 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23314 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23315 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23316 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23317 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23319 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23320 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23321 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23322 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23323 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23324 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23325 control what is done with it.
23327 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23328 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23329 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23330 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23331 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23332 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23333 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23334 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23335 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23336 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23337 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23341 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23342 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23343 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23344 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23345 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23346 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23347 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23348 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23350 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23351 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23352 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23353 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23354 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23355 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23356 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23357 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23358 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23359 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23360 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23361 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23362 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23363 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23364 &`USER `& see below
23366 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23367 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23368 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23369 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23370 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23371 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23372 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23375 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23376 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23377 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23381 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23382 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23383 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23384 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23387 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23388 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23392 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23393 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23394 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23395 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23396 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23397 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23398 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23399 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23400 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23401 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23402 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23405 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23407 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23408 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23409 &%use_shell%& is set.
23412 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23413 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23416 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23417 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23418 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23421 .option check_string pipe string unset
23422 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23423 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23424 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23425 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23426 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23427 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23428 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23432 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23433 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23434 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23435 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23436 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23437 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23438 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23441 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23442 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23443 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23444 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23445 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23446 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23447 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23450 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23451 See &%check_string%& above.
23454 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23455 .cindex "exec failure"
23456 .cindex "failure of exec"
23457 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23458 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23459 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23460 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23461 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23464 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23465 .cindex "signal exit"
23466 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23467 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23468 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23469 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23472 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23473 .cindex "force command"
23474 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23475 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23476 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23477 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23478 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23479 command. For example:
23481 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23485 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23486 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23487 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23490 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23491 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23492 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23493 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23494 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23495 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23497 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23498 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23501 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23502 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23503 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23504 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23505 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23506 written to the main log.
23509 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23510 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23511 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23512 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23513 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23514 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23518 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23519 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23520 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23521 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23522 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23525 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23526 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23527 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23528 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23529 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23530 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23531 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23532 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23535 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23536 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23537 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23540 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23544 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23545 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23546 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23547 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23548 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23553 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23554 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23557 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23558 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23559 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23560 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23564 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23565 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23568 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23569 This option is expanded and
23570 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23571 variable of the subprocess.
23572 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23573 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23574 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23577 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23578 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23579 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23580 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23581 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23582 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23583 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23584 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23585 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23588 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23589 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23590 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23591 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23592 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23593 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23594 accept the message is used.
23597 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23598 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23599 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23600 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23601 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23602 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23605 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23606 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23607 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23608 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23609 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23610 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23611 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23615 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23616 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23617 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23618 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23619 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23620 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23621 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23622 of them may be set.
23626 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23627 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23628 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23629 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23630 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23631 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23632 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23633 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23634 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23635 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23636 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23637 and 73, respectively.
23640 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23641 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23642 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23643 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23644 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23645 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23646 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23648 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23649 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23650 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23651 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23652 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23653 delivery to be deferred.
23655 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23656 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23659 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23660 .cindex "envelope sender"
23661 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23662 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23663 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23664 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23665 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23667 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23668 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23669 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23670 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23671 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23672 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23676 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23677 .cindex "carriage return"
23679 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23680 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23681 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23682 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23684 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23685 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23686 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23687 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23688 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23691 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23692 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23693 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23694 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23695 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23696 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23697 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23698 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23699 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23704 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23705 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23706 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23707 .cindex "external local delivery"
23708 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23709 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23710 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23711 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23712 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23713 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23714 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23715 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23716 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23717 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23722 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23726 check_string = "From "
23727 escape_string = ">From "
23736 transport = procmail_pipe
23738 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23739 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23740 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23741 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23742 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23743 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23745 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23749 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23750 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23753 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23754 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23757 local_delivery_cyrus:
23759 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23760 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23772 local_part_suffix = .*
23773 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23775 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23776 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23778 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23779 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23782 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23783 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23785 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23786 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23787 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23788 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23789 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23790 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23791 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23792 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23795 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23796 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23800 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23801 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23802 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23803 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23804 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23805 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23806 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23808 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23809 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23810 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23811 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23812 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23813 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23818 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23819 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23820 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23824 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23826 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23827 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23828 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23829 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23830 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23831 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23832 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23833 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23836 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23837 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23838 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23839 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23840 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23841 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23842 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23843 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23844 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23845 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23846 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23847 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23848 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23849 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23851 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23852 and will be removed in a future release.
23855 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23856 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23857 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23860 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23861 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23862 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23863 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23864 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23865 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23866 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23867 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23869 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23870 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23871 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23872 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23873 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23874 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23875 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23876 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23877 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23880 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23882 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23883 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23884 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23885 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23886 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23889 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23890 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23891 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23892 particular connection.
23894 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23895 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23896 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23897 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23899 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23900 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23901 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23903 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23905 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23906 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23908 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23909 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23913 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23914 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23915 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23916 authenticated as a client.
23919 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23920 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23921 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23922 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23925 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23926 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23927 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23928 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23929 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23930 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23931 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23934 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23935 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23936 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23937 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23938 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23939 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23940 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23945 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23946 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
23947 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23948 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
23949 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
23950 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
23951 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
23952 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
23953 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
23954 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
23955 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
23956 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
23957 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
23958 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
23962 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23963 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23964 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23965 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23968 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23969 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23970 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23971 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23972 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23973 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23974 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23975 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23976 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23979 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23980 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23981 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23984 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23985 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23986 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23987 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23988 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23989 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23991 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23992 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23993 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23994 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23995 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23996 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23997 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23998 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24002 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24003 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24004 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24005 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24006 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24009 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24010 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24011 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24012 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24016 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24017 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24018 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24019 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24020 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24021 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24022 the dnssec request bit set.
24023 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24027 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24028 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24029 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24030 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24031 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24032 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24033 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24034 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24035 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24039 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24040 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24041 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24042 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24043 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24044 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24045 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24047 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24048 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24049 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24050 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24051 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24054 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24055 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24056 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24057 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24058 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24059 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24060 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24061 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24063 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24064 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24065 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24066 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24067 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24068 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24070 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24071 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24072 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24073 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24074 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24076 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24077 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24078 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24079 copy of the message is sent.
24081 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24082 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24083 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24084 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24088 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24089 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24090 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24093 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24094 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24095 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24096 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24097 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24098 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24100 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24101 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24102 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24103 implementations of TLS.
24105 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24106 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24107 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24108 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24109 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24110 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24111 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24116 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24117 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24118 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24119 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24120 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24121 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24122 interface address, you could use this:
24124 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24125 {$primary_hostname}}
24127 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24130 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24131 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24132 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24133 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24134 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24135 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24137 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24138 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24139 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24140 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24142 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24143 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24144 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24145 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24146 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24147 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24148 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24150 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24151 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24152 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24153 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24154 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24155 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24156 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24159 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24160 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24163 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24164 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24165 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24166 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24167 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24168 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24169 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24170 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24171 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24172 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24175 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24176 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24177 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24178 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24181 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24182 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24183 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24184 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24186 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24187 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24188 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24189 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24190 to any host that matches this list.
24193 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24194 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24195 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24196 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24197 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24198 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24199 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24200 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24203 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24204 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24205 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24210 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24211 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24212 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24213 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24214 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24215 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24216 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24217 explanation of when this might be needed.
24219 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24220 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24221 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24222 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24223 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24224 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24225 message on the same session.
24227 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24228 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24229 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24230 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24231 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24232 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24237 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24238 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24239 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24240 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24241 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24244 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24245 .cindex "randomized host list"
24246 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24247 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24248 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24249 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24250 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24251 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24252 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24253 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24255 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24256 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24257 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24258 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24260 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24262 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24263 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24264 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24266 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24267 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24268 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24269 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24270 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24271 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24272 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24273 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24274 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24277 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24278 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24279 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24280 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24281 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24284 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24285 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24286 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24287 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24288 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24289 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24290 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24291 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24294 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24295 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24296 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24297 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24298 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24300 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24301 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24302 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24303 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24304 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24305 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24307 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24308 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24309 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24310 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24311 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24312 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24313 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24315 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24316 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24317 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24318 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24319 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24320 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24321 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24324 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24325 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24326 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24327 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24328 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24329 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24330 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24331 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24332 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24335 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24336 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24337 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24338 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24339 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24340 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24341 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24342 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24343 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24344 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24346 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24347 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24349 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24350 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24351 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24352 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24353 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24355 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24356 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24357 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24358 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24359 for multi-recipient messages.
24360 The option can usually be left as default.
24362 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24363 .cindex "bind IP address"
24364 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24366 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24367 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24368 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24369 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24370 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24371 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24372 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24373 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24376 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24377 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24378 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24379 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24380 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24381 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24383 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24385 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24386 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24387 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24388 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24391 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24392 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24393 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24394 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24395 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24396 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24397 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24398 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24399 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24400 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24404 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24405 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24406 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24407 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24408 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24410 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24411 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24412 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24413 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24414 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24418 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24419 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24420 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24421 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24422 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24423 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24424 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24425 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24427 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24428 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24429 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24431 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24432 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24433 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24434 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24435 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24436 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24437 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24438 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24440 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24441 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24442 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24443 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24448 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24449 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24450 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24451 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24453 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24454 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24455 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24456 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24457 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24459 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24460 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24461 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24462 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24465 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24466 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24467 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24468 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24469 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24470 addresses is not affected.
24472 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24473 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24474 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24475 Exim to use only the host name.
24476 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24479 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24480 .cindex "serializing connections"
24481 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24482 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24483 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24484 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24485 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24486 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24487 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24489 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24490 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24491 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24492 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24493 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24494 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24496 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24497 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24498 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24499 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24500 are used for ETRN serialization.
24502 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24505 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24506 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24507 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24508 .cindex "size" "of message"
24509 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24510 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24511 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24512 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24513 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24514 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24515 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24516 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24518 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24519 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24522 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24523 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24524 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24525 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24528 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24529 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24530 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24532 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24533 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24534 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24535 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24536 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24539 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24540 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24541 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24542 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24546 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24547 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24548 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24549 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24550 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24553 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24554 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24555 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24556 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24557 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24558 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24561 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24564 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24565 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24567 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24568 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24569 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24570 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24571 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24572 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24573 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24574 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24577 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24578 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24579 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24581 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24582 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24583 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24584 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24585 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24586 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24587 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24588 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24589 ciphers is a preference order.
24593 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24594 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24595 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24596 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24597 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24598 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24599 certificate and private key for the session.
24601 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24603 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24609 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24610 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24611 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24612 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24613 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24614 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24615 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24616 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24617 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24618 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24622 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24623 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24624 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24625 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24626 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24627 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24628 Note that unless the host is in this list
24629 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24630 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24631 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24632 certificate verification succeeds.
24635 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24636 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24637 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24638 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24639 while verifying the server certificate,
24640 checks will be included on the host name
24641 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24642 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24643 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24645 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24648 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24649 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24650 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24652 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24653 The value of this option must be either the
24655 or the absolute path to
24656 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24657 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24659 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24660 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24661 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24664 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24665 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24667 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24669 either by file or directory
24670 are added to those given by the system default location.
24672 The values of &$host$& and
24673 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24674 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24676 For back-compatibility,
24677 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24678 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24679 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24682 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24683 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24684 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24685 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24686 certificate verification must succeed.
24687 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24688 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24689 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24694 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24696 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24697 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24698 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24699 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24700 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24703 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24704 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24705 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24706 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24709 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24710 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24711 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24713 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24714 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24715 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24716 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24717 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24719 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24720 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24721 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24722 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24723 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24724 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24725 see below for an exception).
24727 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24728 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24729 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24730 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24731 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24733 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24734 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24735 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24736 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24737 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24738 reached their retry times.
24740 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24741 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24742 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24743 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24744 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24745 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24746 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24747 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24748 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24749 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24752 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24753 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24754 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24755 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24756 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24757 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24759 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24760 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24761 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24762 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24763 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24764 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24770 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24773 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24774 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24775 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24776 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24777 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24778 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24780 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24781 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24782 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24783 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24784 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24785 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24786 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24788 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24789 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24790 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24791 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24794 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24795 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24796 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24797 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24799 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24800 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24801 facility; you do not have to use it.
24803 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24804 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24805 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24806 address to which it applies.
24808 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24809 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24810 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24811 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24812 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24813 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24816 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24817 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24818 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24819 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24822 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24823 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24824 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24825 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24826 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24829 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24830 illustrated by these examples:
24833 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24834 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24835 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24836 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24838 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24839 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24844 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24845 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24846 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24847 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24848 message's processing.
24850 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24851 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24852 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24853 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24854 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24855 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24856 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24857 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24858 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24860 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24861 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24862 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24863 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24864 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24865 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24866 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24867 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24868 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24869 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24871 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24872 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24873 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24874 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24875 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24876 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24878 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24879 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24880 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24882 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24883 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24884 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24885 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24886 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24887 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24888 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24889 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24890 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24892 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24893 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24899 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24900 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24901 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24902 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24903 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24904 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24905 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24906 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24907 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24908 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24910 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24912 might produce the output
24914 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24915 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24916 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24917 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24918 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24919 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24920 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24921 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24923 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24924 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24925 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24926 set for a particular transport.
24929 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24930 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24931 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24934 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24936 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24937 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24938 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24939 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24941 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24942 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24943 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24944 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24947 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24948 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24949 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24951 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24952 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24953 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24954 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24955 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24956 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24957 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24959 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24960 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24961 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24962 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24963 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24967 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24968 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24971 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24972 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24973 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24974 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24975 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24976 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24977 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24978 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24979 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24981 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24982 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24983 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24985 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24986 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24987 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24988 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24989 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24990 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24991 of pattern they are set as follows:
24994 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24995 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24996 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24999 *queen@*.fict.example
25001 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25003 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25007 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25008 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25011 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25012 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25013 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25014 rewriting rule of the form
25016 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25018 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25024 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25025 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25026 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25027 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25028 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25032 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25033 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25034 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25035 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25036 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25038 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25040 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25043 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25044 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25045 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25046 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25047 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25048 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25049 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25050 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25051 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25052 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25053 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25054 entry written to the panic log.
25058 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25059 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25062 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25065 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25067 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25070 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25071 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25075 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25077 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25078 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25079 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25080 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25081 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25082 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25084 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25085 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25086 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25087 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25088 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25089 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25090 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25091 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25092 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25093 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25095 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25096 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25097 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25099 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25100 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25103 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25104 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25105 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25106 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25107 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25108 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25109 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25110 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25111 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25113 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25114 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25115 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25116 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25117 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25118 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25119 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25120 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25123 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25124 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25125 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25126 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25129 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25130 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25131 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25133 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25134 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25135 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25136 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25138 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25139 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25140 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25142 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25143 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25144 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25145 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25147 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25151 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25154 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25155 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25156 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25157 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25158 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25159 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25160 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25161 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25163 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25164 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25168 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25169 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25171 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25172 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25173 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25175 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25176 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25177 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25178 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25179 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25180 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25181 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25182 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25184 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25185 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25187 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25189 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25190 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25192 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25193 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25194 messages that originate outside the local host:
25196 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25197 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25199 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25202 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25203 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25204 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25205 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25206 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25207 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25208 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25209 components. For example, the rule
25211 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25213 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25214 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25215 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25216 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25217 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25218 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25219 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25226 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25229 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25230 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25231 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25232 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25233 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25234 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25235 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25236 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25237 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25238 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25239 address, domain and error.
25241 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25242 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25243 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25244 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25245 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25246 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25247 log selector is set, the message
25248 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25249 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25250 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25251 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25253 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25254 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25255 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25256 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25257 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25258 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25259 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25260 domain are maintained independently.
25262 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25263 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25264 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25265 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25266 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25267 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25268 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25269 the local address is reached.
25271 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25272 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25273 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25274 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25275 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25277 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25278 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25279 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25280 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25281 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25282 messages that it should now be retaining.
25286 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25287 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25288 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25289 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25290 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25291 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25292 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25293 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25294 message's sender, respectively.
25297 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25298 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25299 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25300 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25301 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25302 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25305 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25307 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25310 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25312 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25313 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25316 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25317 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25318 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25319 expressions work in address lists.
25321 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25322 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25326 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25327 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25328 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25329 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25330 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25331 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25332 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25333 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25334 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25336 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25337 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25338 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25339 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25342 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25343 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25344 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25345 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25346 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25347 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25348 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25349 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25350 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25351 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25356 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25358 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25359 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25360 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25361 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25362 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25363 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25365 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25369 and the retry rules are
25371 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25372 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25374 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25375 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25376 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25377 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25378 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25379 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25381 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25382 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25383 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25384 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25386 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25387 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25388 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25390 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25392 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25393 textual form of the IP address.
25395 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25396 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25397 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25398 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25401 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25402 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25403 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25405 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25406 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25407 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25409 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25410 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25412 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25413 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25416 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25417 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25418 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25419 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25420 retry rule of this form:
25422 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25424 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25425 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25428 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25429 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25430 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25431 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25434 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25435 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25436 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25437 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25438 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25440 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25441 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25443 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25444 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25447 A connection was refused.
25449 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25450 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25452 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25453 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25455 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25456 A connection attempt timed out.
25458 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25459 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25460 obtained from an MX record.
25462 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25463 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25464 obtained from an MX record.
25467 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25469 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25470 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25471 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25472 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25475 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25478 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25479 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25480 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25481 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25482 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25483 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25487 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25488 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25489 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25490 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25491 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25495 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25496 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25497 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25499 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25500 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25501 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25502 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25503 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25504 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25505 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25507 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25508 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25511 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25512 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25513 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25518 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25519 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25520 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25521 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25522 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25525 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25527 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25529 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25531 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25532 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25535 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25537 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25538 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25539 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25540 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25541 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25543 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25544 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25546 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25548 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25549 list is never matched.
25555 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25556 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25557 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25558 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25560 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25562 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25563 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25564 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25565 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25566 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25568 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25569 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25570 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25571 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25572 The available algorithms are:
25575 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25578 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25579 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25580 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25582 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25583 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25584 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25585 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25586 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25587 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25588 queue processing times.
25591 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25592 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25593 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25594 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25595 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25596 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25597 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25598 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25599 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25600 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25601 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25602 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25604 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25605 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25606 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25607 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25608 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25609 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25612 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25613 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25614 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25615 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25616 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25617 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25618 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25619 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25620 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25621 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25622 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25623 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25625 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25626 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25627 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25628 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25629 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25630 deliveries that have been deferred.
25633 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25634 Here are some example retry rules:
25636 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25637 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25638 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25639 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25640 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25641 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25643 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25644 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25645 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25646 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25647 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25648 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25649 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25652 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25653 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25654 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25655 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25656 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25658 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25659 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25660 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25661 were not obtained from an MX record.
25663 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25664 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25665 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25666 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25667 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25671 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25672 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25673 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25674 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25675 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25676 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25677 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25678 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25679 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25680 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25681 failing for the first time.
25683 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25684 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25685 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25686 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25688 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25689 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25690 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25695 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25696 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25697 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25698 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25699 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25700 default retry rule:
25702 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25704 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25705 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25706 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25708 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25709 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25710 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25711 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25712 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25714 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25715 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25716 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25718 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25719 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25720 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25721 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25722 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25723 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25724 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25725 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25727 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25728 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25729 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25730 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25731 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25734 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25735 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25736 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25737 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25738 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25739 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25740 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25741 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25742 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25745 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25746 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25747 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25748 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25749 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25750 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25751 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25752 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25755 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25756 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25757 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25758 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25759 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25760 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25761 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25762 time out the address.
25764 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25765 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25766 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25767 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25768 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25769 considered immediately.
25770 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25771 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25778 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25779 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25781 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25782 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25783 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25784 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25785 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25786 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25787 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25788 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25789 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25792 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25793 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25796 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25797 the client's EHLO command.
25799 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25800 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25802 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25803 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25804 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25805 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25806 with the AUTH command.
25808 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25810 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25811 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25812 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25815 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25816 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25817 unauthenticated connection.
25820 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25821 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25822 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25823 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25825 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25826 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25827 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25828 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
25829 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25830 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25831 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25832 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25837 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25838 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25839 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25840 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25841 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25842 included by setting
25845 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25848 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25853 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25854 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25855 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25856 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25857 work via a socket interface.
25858 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25859 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25860 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25861 supporting setting a server keytab.
25862 The sixth can be configured to support
25863 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25864 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25865 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25866 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25867 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25869 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25870 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25871 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25872 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25873 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25874 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25875 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25877 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25878 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25879 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25880 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25881 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25882 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25886 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25887 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25889 client_secret = secret2
25891 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25892 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25894 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25895 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25896 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25899 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25900 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25901 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25902 authenticating data.
25904 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25905 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25906 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25907 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25908 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25909 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25910 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25911 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25912 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25913 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25916 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25917 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25918 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25919 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25923 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25924 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25925 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25927 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25928 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25929 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25930 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25931 encrypted by a setting such as:
25933 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25937 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25938 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25939 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25940 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25943 .option driver authenticators string unset
25944 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25945 authenticators is to be used.
25948 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25949 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25950 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25951 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25952 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25953 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25956 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25957 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25958 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25959 mechanism is not advertised.
25960 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25961 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25962 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25965 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25966 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25967 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25970 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25971 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25973 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25974 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25975 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25976 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25977 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25978 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25979 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25980 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25981 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25985 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25986 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25987 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25988 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25989 out the values of variables.
25990 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25991 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25994 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25995 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25996 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25997 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25998 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25999 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26000 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26001 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26002 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26005 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26006 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26007 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26008 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26009 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26010 remembered for later use.
26011 How it is used is described in the following section.
26017 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26018 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26019 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26020 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26021 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26025 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26026 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26028 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26030 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26031 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26032 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26033 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26034 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26035 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26036 given for the MAIL command.
26038 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26039 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26042 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26043 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26044 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26045 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26046 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26047 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26048 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26053 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26054 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26055 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26056 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26058 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26059 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26060 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26061 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26062 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26067 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26068 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26069 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26070 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26074 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26076 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26077 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26080 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26081 the mechanisms are advertised.
26083 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26084 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26085 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26086 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26087 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26088 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26089 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26091 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26093 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26095 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26096 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26097 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26100 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26102 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26103 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26104 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26106 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26107 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26108 command. This is the case if
26111 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26113 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26115 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26116 server authenticators.
26120 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26121 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26122 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26124 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26125 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26126 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26127 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26128 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26129 rejected with a 504 error.
26131 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26132 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26133 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26134 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26135 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26136 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26137 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26138 no successful authentication.
26141 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26142 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26143 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26149 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26150 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26151 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26152 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26153 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26154 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26155 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26159 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26161 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26162 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26163 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26164 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26165 command line to run this script on such data might be
26167 encode '\0user\0password'
26169 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26170 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26171 whose code value is zero.
26173 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26174 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26175 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26176 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26178 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26179 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26180 example, a command such as
26182 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26184 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26186 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26187 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26189 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26191 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26192 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26193 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26194 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26198 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26199 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26200 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26201 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26202 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26203 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26206 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26207 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26208 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26209 of the authenticator.
26212 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26213 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26214 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26215 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26216 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26217 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26218 delivery to be deferred.
26220 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26221 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26222 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26225 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26226 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26227 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26228 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26229 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26230 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26231 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26232 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26233 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26236 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26237 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26238 on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
26239 router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
26240 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26241 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26242 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26243 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26245 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26247 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26248 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26249 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26250 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26251 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26252 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26253 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26254 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26255 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26256 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26257 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26258 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26259 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26266 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26269 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26270 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26271 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26272 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26273 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26274 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26275 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26276 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26277 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26278 connections as you do for login accounts.
26280 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26281 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26282 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26284 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26285 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26286 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26288 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26289 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26290 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26293 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26294 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26295 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26296 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26297 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26298 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26299 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26301 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26302 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26303 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26304 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26305 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26306 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26307 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26309 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26310 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26311 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26312 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26314 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26315 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26316 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26318 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26319 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26320 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26321 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26322 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26323 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26324 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26325 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26326 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26327 string as the error text
26329 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26330 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26331 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26335 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26336 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26337 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26338 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26339 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26340 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26341 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26342 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26344 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26345 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26346 configured as follows:
26350 public_name = PLAIN
26352 server_condition = \
26353 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26354 server_set_id = $auth2
26356 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26357 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26358 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26359 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26361 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26362 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26363 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26364 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26368 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26370 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26372 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26373 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26377 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26378 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26380 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26381 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26382 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26383 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26384 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26386 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26387 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26388 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26390 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26391 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26392 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26393 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26394 This is an incorrect example:
26396 server_condition = \
26397 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26399 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26400 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26401 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26402 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26403 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26404 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26405 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26407 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26408 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26410 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26411 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26412 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26413 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26414 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26417 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26418 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26419 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26420 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26421 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26422 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26423 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26427 public_name = LOGIN
26428 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26429 server_condition = \
26430 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26431 server_set_id = $auth1
26433 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26434 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26435 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26436 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26438 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26439 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26440 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26441 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26442 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26446 public_name = LOGIN
26447 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26448 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26451 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26452 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26453 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26454 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26456 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26457 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26458 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26459 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26460 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26461 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26462 uninterpreted string.
26465 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26466 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26467 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26468 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26469 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26475 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26476 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26477 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26479 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26480 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26481 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26482 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26485 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26486 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26487 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26488 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26489 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26490 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26491 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26492 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26493 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26494 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26495 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26496 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26498 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26499 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26501 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26502 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26503 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26504 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26507 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26508 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26512 public_name = PLAIN
26513 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26515 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26516 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26517 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26521 public_name = LOGIN
26522 client_send = : username : mysecret
26524 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26525 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26527 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26528 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26533 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26534 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26536 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26537 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26538 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26539 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26540 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26541 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26542 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26543 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26544 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26545 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26546 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26547 available in plain text at either end.
26550 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26551 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26552 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26553 authenticator as a server:
26555 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26556 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26557 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26558 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26559 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26560 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26561 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26562 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26563 returned to the client.
26565 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26566 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26567 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26568 numeric variables for other things.
26570 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26571 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26572 user name, authentication fails.
26576 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26577 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26578 server_set_id = $auth1
26580 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26581 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26582 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26583 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26587 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26588 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26590 server_set_id = $auth1
26592 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26593 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26595 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26596 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26597 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26602 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26603 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26604 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26605 server_set_id = $auth1
26608 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26609 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26610 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26614 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26615 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26616 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26619 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26620 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26621 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26625 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26626 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26627 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26628 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26629 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26630 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26631 send the message to the current server.
26633 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26638 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26640 client_secret = secret
26642 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26643 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26647 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26650 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26651 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26652 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26653 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26655 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26656 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26658 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26659 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26660 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26661 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26662 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26664 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26665 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26666 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26667 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26669 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26670 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26671 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26672 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26673 depending on the driver you are using.
26675 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26676 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26677 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26678 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26679 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26682 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26683 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26684 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26685 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26686 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26687 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26688 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26689 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26692 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26693 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26694 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26695 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26696 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26697 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26701 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26702 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26703 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26704 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26707 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26708 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26709 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26710 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26714 driver = cyrus_sasl
26715 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26716 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26717 server_set_id = $auth1
26720 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26721 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26724 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26725 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26728 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26729 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26730 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26731 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26734 driver = cyrus_sasl
26735 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26736 server_set_id = $auth1
26739 driver = cyrus_sasl
26740 public_name = PLAIN
26741 server_set_id = $auth2
26743 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26744 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26745 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26746 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26747 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26752 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26753 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26754 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26755 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26756 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26757 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26758 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26759 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26760 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26761 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26762 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26764 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26766 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26767 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26768 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26769 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26773 public_name = PLAIN
26774 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26775 server_set_id = $auth1
26780 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26781 server_set_id = $auth1
26783 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26784 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26785 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26786 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26787 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26788 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26789 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26790 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26795 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26796 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26797 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26798 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26799 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26800 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26801 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26802 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26803 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26804 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26805 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26806 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26807 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26808 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26809 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26810 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26811 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26812 without code changes in Exim.
26815 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26816 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26817 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26818 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26819 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26822 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26823 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26824 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26826 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26827 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26828 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26830 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26831 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26832 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26835 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26836 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26837 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26838 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26841 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26842 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26843 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26844 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26849 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26850 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26851 server_set_id = $auth1
26855 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26856 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26857 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26858 the password itself.
26860 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26861 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26862 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26863 if available, else the empty string.
26864 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26865 else the empty string.
26867 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26869 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26870 option to be simply "true".
26873 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26874 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26875 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26878 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26879 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26880 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26881 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26884 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26885 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26886 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26887 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26890 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26891 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26892 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26895 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26896 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26897 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26898 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26900 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26901 meanings for these variables:
26904 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26905 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26907 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26908 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26910 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26911 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26914 On a per-mechanism basis:
26917 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26918 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26919 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26921 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26922 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26923 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26925 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26926 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26927 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26928 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26931 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26932 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26933 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26936 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26937 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26939 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26941 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26942 server_realm = imap.example.org
26943 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26944 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26945 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26946 server_condition = yes
26950 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26951 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26953 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26954 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26955 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26956 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26957 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26958 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26959 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26962 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26963 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26964 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26965 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26967 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26968 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26969 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26970 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26972 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26973 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26974 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26978 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26979 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26980 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26981 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26983 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26984 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26985 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26986 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26988 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26990 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26991 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26993 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26994 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26995 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27000 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27003 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27004 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27005 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27006 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27007 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27008 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27009 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27010 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27011 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27012 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27013 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27014 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
27015 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27019 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27020 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27022 The server sends back a challenge.
27024 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27025 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27028 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27032 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27033 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27034 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27036 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27037 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27038 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27039 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27040 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27041 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27042 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27043 for other things. For example:
27048 server_password = \
27049 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27051 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27052 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27058 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27059 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27060 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27064 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27065 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27068 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27069 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27072 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27073 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27074 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27080 client_username = msn/msn_username
27081 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27082 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27084 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27085 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27091 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27092 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27094 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27095 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27096 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27097 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27098 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27099 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27100 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27101 authentication based on client certificates.
27103 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27104 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27105 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27106 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27107 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27108 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27110 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27111 for which it must have been requested via the
27112 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27113 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27115 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27116 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27117 and can authenticate the connection.
27118 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27120 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27123 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27124 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27126 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27127 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27128 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27129 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27130 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27131 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27133 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27134 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27135 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27137 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27144 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27145 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27146 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27148 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27149 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27150 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27152 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27154 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27155 of your configured trust-anchors
27156 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27157 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27158 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27159 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27161 . An alternative might use
27163 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27165 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27166 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27167 . This would help for per-device use.
27169 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27170 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27172 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27173 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27176 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27177 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27178 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27182 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27183 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27185 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27186 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27187 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27188 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27189 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27192 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27193 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27194 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27195 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27196 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27197 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27198 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27199 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27200 certificates are used.
27202 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27203 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27204 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27205 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27206 between them is encrypted.
27208 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27209 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27210 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27211 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27214 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27215 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27216 in order to get TLS to work.
27220 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27222 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27223 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27224 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27225 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27226 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27227 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27228 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27229 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27230 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27231 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27232 in preference to STARTTLS.
27234 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27235 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27236 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27238 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27239 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27240 reassigned for other use.
27241 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27243 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only supported submissions, not
27244 submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27245 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27247 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27248 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27249 the most common use is expected to be:
27251 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27253 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27254 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27255 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27256 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27257 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27260 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27261 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27268 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27269 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27270 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27271 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27272 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27276 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27280 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27281 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27283 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27286 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27287 cannot be the path of a directory
27288 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27289 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27291 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27293 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27294 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27295 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27296 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27297 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27299 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27300 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27301 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27302 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27303 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27304 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27305 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27308 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27309 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27311 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27312 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27313 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27314 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27316 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27317 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27319 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27320 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27321 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27322 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27326 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27327 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27328 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27329 but not the chosen filename.
27330 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27331 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27333 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27334 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27335 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27336 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27338 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27339 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27340 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27341 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27342 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27343 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27344 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27346 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27347 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27348 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27349 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27350 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27352 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27353 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27354 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27355 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27356 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27357 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27359 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27360 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27361 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27363 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27364 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27365 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27366 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27369 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27372 # chown exim:exim new-params
27373 # chmod 0600 new-params
27374 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27375 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27376 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27377 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27378 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27379 # chmod 0400 new-params
27380 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27382 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27383 stalling is removed.
27385 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27386 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27387 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27388 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27389 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27390 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27391 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27392 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27393 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27394 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27395 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27397 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27398 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27399 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27400 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27402 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27403 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27404 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27405 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27406 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27409 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27410 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27411 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27412 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27413 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27414 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27415 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27416 directly to this function call.
27417 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27418 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27419 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27420 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27423 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27425 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27426 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27427 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27430 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27431 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27432 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27436 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27439 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27440 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27443 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27444 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27446 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27447 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27450 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27451 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27452 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27453 not be moved to the end of the list.
27456 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27459 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27460 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27463 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27464 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27465 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27466 choice of clients used:
27468 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27469 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27474 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27476 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27480 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27482 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27483 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27484 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27485 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27486 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27487 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27488 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27489 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27490 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27491 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27493 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27494 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27496 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27497 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27498 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27499 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27500 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27501 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27503 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27504 "Priority strings". This is online as
27505 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27506 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27507 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27508 then the example code
27509 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27510 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27514 # Disable older versions of protocols
27515 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27518 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27519 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27520 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27522 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27523 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27524 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27525 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27529 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27535 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27536 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27537 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27538 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27539 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27540 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27541 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27543 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27544 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27546 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27547 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27548 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27551 554 Security failure
27553 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27554 rejected with a 554 error code.
27556 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27557 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27559 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27560 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27561 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27562 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27564 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27566 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27568 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27569 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27571 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27572 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27573 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27574 that goes with it. These files need to be
27575 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27576 always be given as full path names.
27577 The key must not be password-protected.
27578 They can be the same file if both the
27579 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27580 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27581 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27582 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27583 the server's certificate.
27585 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27586 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27587 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27588 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27589 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27590 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27592 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27593 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27594 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27596 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27597 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27598 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27601 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27602 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27603 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27605 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27607 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27608 with the parameters contained in the file.
27609 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27614 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27615 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27616 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27617 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27623 for a way of generating file data.
27625 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27626 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27627 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27628 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27629 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27631 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27632 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27633 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27634 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27635 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27636 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27637 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27638 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27639 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27641 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27642 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27643 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27644 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27645 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27646 documentation for more details.
27648 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27649 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27652 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27653 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27654 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27655 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27656 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27657 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27658 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27659 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27660 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27661 expected certificates.
27662 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27663 an explicit file or,
27664 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27665 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27667 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27670 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27671 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27672 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27674 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27676 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27678 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27679 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27680 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27681 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27682 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27683 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27684 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27685 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27686 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27687 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27689 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27690 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27691 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27692 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27694 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27695 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27696 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27697 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27698 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27699 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27702 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27703 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27704 .cindex "revocation list"
27705 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27706 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27707 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27708 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27709 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27710 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27711 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27713 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27714 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27716 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27717 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27718 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27719 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27720 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27721 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27723 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27724 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27725 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27726 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27728 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27729 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27730 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27731 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27732 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27733 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27734 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27735 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27737 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27738 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27739 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27741 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27742 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27743 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27744 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27745 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27747 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27748 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27749 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27750 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27751 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27754 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27755 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27758 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27759 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27760 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27761 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27762 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27763 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27765 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27766 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27768 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27771 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27772 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27773 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27775 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27776 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27777 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27783 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27784 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27785 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27786 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27787 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27788 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27789 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27790 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27791 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27793 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27794 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27795 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27796 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27797 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27799 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27800 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27801 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27802 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27803 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27806 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27807 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27808 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27809 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27810 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27811 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27812 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27813 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27814 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27815 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27818 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27819 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27820 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27821 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27823 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27824 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27826 the system default set (depending on library version),
27828 or (depending on library version) a directory.
27829 The client verifies the server's certificate
27830 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27831 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27832 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27833 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27835 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27836 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27837 or need not succeed respectively.
27839 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27840 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27841 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27843 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27844 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27845 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27848 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27849 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27850 for OCSP to be relevant.
27853 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27854 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27855 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27856 alternative hosts, if any.
27859 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27860 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27861 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27865 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27866 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27867 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27868 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27869 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27871 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27872 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27873 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27874 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27875 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27876 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27877 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27878 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27879 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27880 outgoing connection.
27884 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27885 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27886 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27887 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27888 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27889 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27890 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27891 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27892 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27893 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27896 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27897 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27900 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27901 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27902 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27903 be of limited use in that environment.
27905 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27906 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27907 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27908 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27909 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27911 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27912 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27913 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27914 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27915 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27917 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27918 received from a client.
27919 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27921 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27922 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27923 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27926 &%tls_certificate%&
27932 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27937 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27938 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27939 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27940 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27941 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27942 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27943 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27945 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27948 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27949 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27950 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27951 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27953 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27954 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27955 built, then you have SNI support).
27959 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27961 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27962 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27963 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27964 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27965 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27966 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27967 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27968 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27969 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27970 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27972 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27973 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27974 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
27975 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27976 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27977 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27978 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27980 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27981 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27982 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27983 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27984 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27985 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27986 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27987 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27988 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27990 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27991 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27992 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27993 information is recorded.
27995 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27996 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27997 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28002 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28003 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28004 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28005 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
28006 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
28007 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
28008 to Apache, currently at
28010 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
28012 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
28013 links to further files.
28014 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28015 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
28016 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
28018 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
28022 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28023 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28024 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28025 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28026 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28027 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28028 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28029 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28030 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28031 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28032 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28033 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28034 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28036 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28037 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28038 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28039 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28043 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28044 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28045 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28046 with OpenSSL, like this:
28047 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28048 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28050 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28053 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28054 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28055 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28056 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28057 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28058 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28059 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28061 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28062 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28063 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28064 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28065 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28066 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28068 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28069 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28070 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28071 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28072 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28073 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28074 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28075 be a sensible resolution).
28077 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28078 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28079 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28081 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28082 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28083 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28084 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28085 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28086 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28088 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28089 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28090 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28091 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
28092 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28093 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28098 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28100 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28101 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28102 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28103 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28104 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28105 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28107 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28108 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28109 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28111 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28112 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28114 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28115 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28116 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28118 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28119 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28120 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28122 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28123 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28125 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28126 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28127 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28128 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28130 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3). The latter specifies
28131 the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server (and should be the sole one transmitted
28132 during the TLS handshake); this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28133 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28134 well-known one. A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate which is used to sign
28135 cerver certificates, but running one securely does require careful arrangement. If a private CA is used
28136 then either all clients must be primed with it, or (probably simpler) the server TLS handshake must transmit
28137 the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate. If a public CA is used then all clients must be primed with it
28138 (losing one advantage of DANE) - but the attack surface is reduced from all public CAs to that single CA.
28139 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28140 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28142 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28144 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28145 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28148 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28149 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28154 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28156 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28158 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28159 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28160 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28163 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28164 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28168 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28169 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28170 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28171 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28172 control the OCSP request.
28174 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28175 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28178 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28179 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28180 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28182 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28184 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28185 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28186 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28187 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28189 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28190 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28191 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28192 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28193 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28194 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28195 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28197 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28201 tls_try_verify_hosts
28202 tls_verify_certificates
28204 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28207 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28208 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28210 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28212 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28214 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28215 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28216 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28217 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28219 .cindex DANE reporting
28220 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28221 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28222 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28223 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28224 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28225 Section 4.3 of that document.
28227 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28232 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28235 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28236 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28237 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28238 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28239 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28240 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28241 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28242 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28243 one very small ACL:
28247 accept hosts = one.host.only
28249 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28250 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28252 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28253 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28254 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28255 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28256 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28257 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28258 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28259 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28262 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28263 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28264 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28267 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28268 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28269 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28270 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28271 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28272 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28273 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28274 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28275 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28276 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28277 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28278 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28279 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28280 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28281 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28282 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28283 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28284 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28285 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28286 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28289 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28290 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28291 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28292 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28293 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28294 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28295 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28296 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28297 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28298 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28299 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28300 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28301 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28302 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28303 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28304 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28305 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28306 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28307 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28308 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28311 For example, if you set
28313 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28315 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28316 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28317 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28318 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28319 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28320 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28321 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28324 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28325 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28326 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28327 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28328 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28329 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28330 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28331 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28332 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28333 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28334 in any of these ACLs.
28336 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28337 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28338 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28339 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28340 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28341 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28342 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28343 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28345 control = suppress_local_fixups
28347 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28348 run, it is too late.
28350 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28351 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28353 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28354 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28355 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28358 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28359 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28360 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28361 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28362 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28363 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28364 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28365 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28366 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28369 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28370 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28371 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28372 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28373 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28374 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28375 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28376 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28377 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28379 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28380 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28381 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28383 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28384 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28385 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28386 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28390 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28391 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28392 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28393 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28394 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28395 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28396 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28397 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28398 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28399 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28401 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28402 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28403 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28404 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28405 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28406 associated with the DATA command.
28408 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28409 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28410 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28411 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28412 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28413 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28414 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28415 the data specified is received.
28417 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28418 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28419 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28420 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28421 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28424 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28425 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28426 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28427 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28429 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28430 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28431 enabled (which is the default).
28433 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28434 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28435 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28437 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28439 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28442 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28443 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28444 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28446 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28449 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28450 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28451 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28452 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28453 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28454 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28455 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28458 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28459 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28460 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28461 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28462 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28463 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28464 for some or all recipients.
28466 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28467 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28468 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28469 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28470 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28472 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28473 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28474 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28476 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28477 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28479 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28480 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28481 the feature was not requested by the client.
28483 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28484 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28485 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28486 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28487 does not in fact control any access.
28488 For this reason, it may only accept
28489 or warn as its final result.
28491 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28492 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28493 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28494 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28496 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28497 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28499 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28500 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28503 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28504 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28505 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28506 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28507 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28510 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28511 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28512 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28513 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28514 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28515 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28516 situation even worse.
28518 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28519 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28520 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28523 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28524 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28525 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28526 connection. The possible values are:
28528 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28529 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28530 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28531 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28532 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28533 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28534 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28535 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28536 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28537 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28539 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28540 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28541 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28542 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28543 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28547 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28548 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28549 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28550 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28552 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28553 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28555 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28556 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28557 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28558 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28559 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28561 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28562 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28563 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28566 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28567 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28568 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28569 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28570 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28571 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28573 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28574 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28575 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28577 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28578 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28579 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28580 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28582 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28583 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28584 matches the string.
28586 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28587 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28588 want to have something like
28590 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28592 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28593 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28599 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28600 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28601 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28602 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28603 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28604 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28605 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28606 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28607 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28609 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28610 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28611 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28614 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28615 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28616 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28617 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28619 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28620 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28621 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28622 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28623 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28624 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28625 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28627 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28628 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28631 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28632 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28633 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28637 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28638 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28639 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28640 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28641 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28642 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28644 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28645 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28646 used to accept or reject anything.
28648 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28649 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28650 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28651 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28653 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28654 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28655 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28656 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28657 configuration file.
28662 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28663 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28665 .vindex &$local_part$&
28666 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28667 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28668 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28669 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28670 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28671 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28672 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28673 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28674 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28676 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28677 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28678 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28681 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28682 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28683 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28684 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28685 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28688 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28689 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28690 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28691 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28692 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28693 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28694 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28695 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28701 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28702 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28703 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28704 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28705 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28706 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28707 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28708 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28709 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28710 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28711 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28712 unencrypted connections.
28715 accept encrypted = *
28716 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28718 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28720 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28721 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28722 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28723 option to do this.)
28727 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28728 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28729 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28730 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28731 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28732 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28733 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28735 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28736 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28737 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28740 deny dnslists = list1.example
28741 dnslists = list2.example
28743 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28744 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28745 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28746 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28747 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28750 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28751 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28754 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28755 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28756 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28757 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28758 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28759 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28760 check a RCPT command:
28762 accept domains = +local_domains
28766 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28767 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28768 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28769 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28772 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28773 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28774 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28777 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28778 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28779 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28780 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28781 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28782 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28784 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28785 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28787 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28788 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28789 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28791 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28792 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28793 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28798 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28799 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28800 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28801 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28802 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28803 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28804 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28808 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28809 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28810 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28813 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28815 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28819 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28820 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28821 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28822 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28823 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28824 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28825 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28826 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28827 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28829 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28830 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28831 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28835 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28836 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28837 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28839 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28840 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28842 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28843 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28846 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28847 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28848 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28849 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28851 require message = Sender did not verify
28854 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28855 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28856 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28857 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28860 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28861 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28862 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28863 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28864 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28865 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28866 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28868 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28869 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28870 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28871 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28872 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28874 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28875 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28876 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28877 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28878 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28879 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28883 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28884 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28885 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28886 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28888 warn !verify = sender
28889 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28893 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28895 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28896 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28897 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28898 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28899 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28903 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28904 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28905 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28906 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28907 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28908 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28909 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28910 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28911 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28912 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28914 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28915 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28916 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28917 on the same SMTP connection.
28919 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28920 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28921 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28924 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28925 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28926 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28928 accept hosts = whatever
28929 set acl_m4 = some value
28930 accept authenticated = *
28931 set acl_c_auth = yes
28933 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28934 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28935 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28937 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28938 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28939 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28940 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28941 error is generated.
28943 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28944 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28947 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28948 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28949 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28950 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28952 deny domains = *.dom.example
28953 !verify = recipient
28955 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28956 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28957 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28958 two statements are equivalent:
28960 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28961 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28963 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28964 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28966 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28967 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28968 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28970 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28971 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28972 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28973 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28975 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28976 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28977 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28978 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28979 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28980 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28981 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28983 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28984 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28985 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28986 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28987 message is handled.
28989 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28990 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28991 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28992 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28994 require message = Can't verify sender
28996 message = Can't verify recipient
28998 message = This message cannot be used
29000 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29001 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29002 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29003 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29004 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29005 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29007 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29008 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29009 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29010 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29013 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29014 message = Invalid sender from client host
29016 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29017 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29021 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29022 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29023 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29026 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29027 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29028 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29029 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29031 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29032 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29033 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29034 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29035 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29036 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29037 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29038 write rather ugly lines like this:
29040 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29042 Instead, all you need is
29044 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29047 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29048 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29049 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29050 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29051 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29052 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29053 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29054 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29056 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29057 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29058 in several different ways. For example:
29060 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29061 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29062 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29066 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29068 accept ...some conditions
29069 control = queue_only
29071 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29072 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29075 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29077 accept ...some conditions...
29078 control = queue_only
29079 ...some more conditions...
29081 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29082 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29083 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29087 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29088 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29091 warn ...some conditions...
29095 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29096 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29100 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29101 &%require%& verb. For example:
29103 require control = no_multiline_responses
29107 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29108 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29110 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29111 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29112 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29113 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29114 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29115 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29117 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29120 deny ...some conditions...
29123 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29124 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29127 ...some conditions...
29129 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29130 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29132 warn ...some conditions...
29138 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29139 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29140 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29141 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29142 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29143 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29144 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29148 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29149 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29150 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29151 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29152 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29153 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29154 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29157 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29158 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29159 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29160 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29162 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29163 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29165 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29168 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29169 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29171 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29172 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29173 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29176 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29177 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29178 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29179 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29180 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29181 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29184 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29185 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29186 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29189 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29190 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29191 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29192 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29193 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29194 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29196 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29197 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29198 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29199 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29200 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29201 logging rejections.
29204 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29205 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29206 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29207 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29208 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29209 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29210 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29211 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29213 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29214 &` log_reject_target =`&
29216 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29217 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29221 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29222 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29223 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29224 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29225 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29226 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29227 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29230 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29231 &` control = freeze`&
29232 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29234 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29235 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29236 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29239 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29240 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29244 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29245 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29246 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29247 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29248 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29249 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29250 &%accept%& for details.)
29252 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29253 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29254 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29255 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29256 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29258 require message = Host not recognized
29261 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29264 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29265 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29266 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29267 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29268 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29269 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29270 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29271 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29272 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29275 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29276 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29277 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29279 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29280 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29282 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29283 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29284 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29287 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29288 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29290 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29291 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29292 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29295 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29296 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29297 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29299 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29300 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29301 However, the original message is available in the variable
29302 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29303 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29304 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29305 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29307 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29308 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29309 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29310 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29311 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29312 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29316 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29317 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29318 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29319 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29321 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29323 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29324 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29325 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29326 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29329 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29330 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29331 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29332 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29335 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29336 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29337 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29338 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29341 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29342 .cindex "UDP communications"
29343 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29344 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29345 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29346 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29347 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29348 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29349 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29352 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29353 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29360 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29361 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29362 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29365 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29366 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29367 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29368 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29369 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29370 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29371 not work without it. For example:
29373 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29374 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29376 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29377 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29378 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29379 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29380 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29383 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29384 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29385 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29386 .cindex "case of local parts"
29387 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29388 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29389 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29390 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29391 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29392 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29395 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29396 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29397 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29398 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29399 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29401 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29402 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29405 warn control = caseful_local_part
29406 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29408 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29410 control = caselower_local_part
29412 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29413 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29416 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29417 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29418 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29419 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29421 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29422 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29423 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29424 is used for all recipients of the message,
29425 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29426 and data is copied from one to the other.
29428 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29429 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29430 If a recipient-verify callout
29432 connection is subsequently
29433 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29434 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29435 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29437 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29438 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29439 Note also that headers cannot be
29440 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29441 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29442 The Received-By: header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29443 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29444 this will affect the timestamp.
29446 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29447 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29448 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29449 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29452 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29453 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29454 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29455 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29459 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29460 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29461 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29462 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29463 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29465 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29467 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29468 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29469 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29470 and does not queue the message.
29471 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29473 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29475 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29478 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29479 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29480 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29481 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29482 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29483 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29484 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29485 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29486 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29488 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29489 with the &'kill'& option.
29490 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29494 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29495 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29496 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29497 control = debug/kill
29501 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29502 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29503 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29504 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29505 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29508 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29509 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29510 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29511 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29512 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29513 strings or to numeric value.
29514 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29515 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29516 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29518 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29519 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29520 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29521 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29522 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29525 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29526 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29527 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29528 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29529 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29530 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29531 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29532 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29534 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29535 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29536 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29537 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29538 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29539 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29543 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29544 .cindex "fake defer"
29545 .cindex "defer, fake"
29546 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29547 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29548 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29549 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29550 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29552 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29553 .cindex "fake rejection"
29554 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29555 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29556 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29557 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29558 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29559 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29560 the same SMTP connection.
29562 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29563 message is supplied, the following is used:
29565 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29566 550-kept for evaluation.
29567 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29568 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29570 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29572 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29573 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29574 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29575 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29576 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29577 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29580 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29581 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29582 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29583 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29585 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29586 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29587 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29588 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29589 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29590 disables such output flushing.
29592 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29593 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29594 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29595 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29596 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29597 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29599 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29600 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29601 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29602 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29603 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29604 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29605 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29606 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29607 to be useful in production.
29609 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29610 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29611 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29612 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29613 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29615 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29616 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29617 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29618 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29619 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29620 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29623 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29624 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29625 verification failed"&) is sent.
29627 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29631 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29632 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29634 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29635 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29636 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29637 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29638 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29639 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29640 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29642 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29643 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29644 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29645 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29646 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29647 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29648 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29649 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29650 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29651 same SMTP connection.
29653 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29654 .cindex "message" "submission"
29655 .cindex "submission mode"
29656 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29657 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29658 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29659 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29660 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29661 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29662 late (the message has already been created).
29664 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29665 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29666 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29667 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29668 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29670 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29671 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29672 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29673 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29674 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29677 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29678 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29680 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29682 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29685 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29686 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29687 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29688 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29691 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29692 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29694 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29695 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29697 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29701 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29702 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29705 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29707 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29708 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29710 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29712 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29717 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29718 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29719 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29720 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29721 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29722 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29724 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29725 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29726 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29728 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29729 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29730 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29731 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29732 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29735 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29736 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29738 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29739 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29740 contains one or more newlines that
29741 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29742 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29743 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29745 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29746 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29747 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29748 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29749 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29750 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29751 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29752 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29753 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29754 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29755 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29757 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29758 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29760 until they are added to the
29761 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29762 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29763 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29764 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29765 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29766 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29767 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29769 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29771 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29772 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29774 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29775 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29777 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29778 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29780 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29781 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29782 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29783 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29786 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29787 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29788 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29789 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29790 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29791 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29792 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29795 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29796 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29797 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29798 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29799 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29801 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29802 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29803 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29804 to be a header name first.) For example:
29806 warn add_header = \
29807 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29809 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29810 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29811 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29812 up in reverse order.
29814 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29815 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29816 system filter or in a router or transport.
29820 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29821 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29822 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29823 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29824 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29825 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29827 warn message = Remove internal headers
29828 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29830 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29831 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29832 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29833 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29834 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29835 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29837 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29838 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29840 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29841 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29842 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29843 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29844 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29846 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29847 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29848 warn message = Remove internal headers
29849 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29851 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29852 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29853 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29854 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29855 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29856 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29857 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29858 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29859 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29860 would have been removed.
29862 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29863 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29864 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29865 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29866 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29867 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29868 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29869 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29870 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29872 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29873 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29875 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29876 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29878 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29879 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29881 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29882 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29883 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29884 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29887 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29888 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29889 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29894 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29895 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29896 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29897 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29898 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29899 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29901 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29902 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29903 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29904 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29905 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29906 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29907 The conditions are as follows:
29911 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29912 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29913 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29914 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29915 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29916 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29917 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29918 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29919 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29920 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29921 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29922 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29924 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29925 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29926 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29927 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29928 The name and values are expanded separately.
29929 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29930 will act as argument separators.
29932 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29933 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29934 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29935 conditions are tested.
29937 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29938 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29939 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29940 for different local users or different local domains.
29942 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29943 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29944 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29945 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29946 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29947 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29948 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29953 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29954 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29955 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29956 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29957 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29958 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29959 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29960 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29961 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29962 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29963 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29964 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29967 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29968 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29969 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29970 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29971 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29972 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29973 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29974 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29976 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29977 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29978 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29979 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29980 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29981 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29982 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29983 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29984 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29985 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29987 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29988 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29989 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29990 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29991 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29992 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29993 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29994 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29995 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29998 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29999 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30002 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30003 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30004 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30005 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30006 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30007 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30008 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30014 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30015 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30016 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30017 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30018 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30019 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30020 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30022 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30024 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30025 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30026 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30028 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30029 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30030 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30031 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30032 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30033 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30035 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30036 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30038 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30039 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30041 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30042 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30043 statement can then check the IP address.
30045 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30046 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30047 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30048 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30050 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30051 message = $host_data
30053 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30055 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30056 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30057 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30058 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30059 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30060 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30061 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30062 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30063 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30064 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30066 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30067 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30068 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30069 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30070 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30071 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30072 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30074 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30075 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30076 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30077 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30078 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30079 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30080 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30083 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30084 .cindex "rate limiting"
30085 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30086 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30088 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30089 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30090 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30091 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30092 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30093 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30095 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30096 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30097 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30098 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30099 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30100 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30101 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30103 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30104 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30105 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30106 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30107 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30108 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30109 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30110 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30111 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30112 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30113 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30114 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30115 influence the sender checking.
30117 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30118 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30120 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30121 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30122 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30123 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30124 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30125 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30129 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30130 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30132 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30133 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30134 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30135 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30136 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30137 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30139 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30140 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30141 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30142 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30143 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30144 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30145 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30146 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30147 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30148 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30150 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30151 .cindex "CSA verification"
30152 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30153 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30154 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30156 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30157 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30158 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30159 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30160 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30161 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30162 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30163 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30164 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30165 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30167 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30168 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30169 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30171 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30172 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30173 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30174 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30175 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30176 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30177 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30178 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30179 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30180 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30181 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30182 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30183 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30184 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30185 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30187 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30188 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30189 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30190 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30193 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30194 !verify = header_sender
30197 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30198 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30199 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30200 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30201 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30202 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30203 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30204 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30205 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30206 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30207 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30208 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30209 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30212 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30213 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30217 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30218 common as they used to be.
30220 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30221 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30222 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30223 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30224 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30225 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30226 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30227 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30228 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30229 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30230 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30231 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30232 independently of this condition.
30234 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30235 option), this condition is always true.
30238 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30239 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30240 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30241 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30242 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30243 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30244 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30245 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30246 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30248 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30249 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30252 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30253 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30254 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30255 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30256 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30257 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30258 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30259 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30260 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30261 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30262 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30263 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30264 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30265 value for the child address.
30267 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30268 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30269 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30270 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30271 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30272 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30273 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30274 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30275 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30276 original IP address.
30278 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30279 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30281 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30282 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30284 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30285 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30286 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30287 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30288 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30289 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30290 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30291 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30292 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30294 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30295 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30296 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30297 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30298 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30299 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30300 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30302 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30303 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30304 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30306 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30307 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30308 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30309 verified as a sender.
30311 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30312 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30313 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30315 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30321 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30322 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30323 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30324 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30325 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30326 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30327 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30328 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30329 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30330 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30332 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30333 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30335 the following records are looked up:
30337 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30338 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30340 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30341 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30342 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30343 use two separate conditions:
30345 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30346 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30348 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30349 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30350 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30353 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30354 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30355 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30356 following special items in the list:
30358 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30359 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30360 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30362 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30363 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30364 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30365 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30367 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30369 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30370 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30372 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30373 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30374 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30376 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30378 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30379 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30380 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30381 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30382 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30383 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30387 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30388 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30389 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30390 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30391 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30393 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30395 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30396 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30397 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30398 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30403 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30404 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30405 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30406 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30407 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30408 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30409 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30411 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30412 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30414 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30415 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30416 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30417 up by this example is
30419 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30421 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30422 addresses. For example:
30424 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30425 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30427 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30428 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30433 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30434 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30435 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30436 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30437 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30438 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30439 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30440 either to double the separators like this:
30442 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30444 or to change the separator character, like this:
30446 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30448 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30449 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30450 occurs. Consider this condition:
30452 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30454 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30456 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30457 a.domain.black.list.tld
30459 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30460 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30461 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30462 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30463 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30464 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30465 error for a previous item.
30467 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30468 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30470 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30471 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30473 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30474 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30476 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30477 $sender_address_domain \
30478 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30480 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30481 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30482 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30484 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30485 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30486 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30487 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30489 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30491 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30492 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30494 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30495 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30500 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30501 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30502 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30503 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30504 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30505 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30509 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30511 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30512 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30513 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30515 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30516 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30517 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30520 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30521 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30522 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30523 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30524 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30525 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30526 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30527 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30528 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30529 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30530 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30531 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30532 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30533 cases, for example:
30535 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30537 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30538 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30539 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30540 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30542 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30544 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30545 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30547 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30548 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30549 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30550 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30551 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30554 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30555 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30556 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30558 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30559 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30561 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30566 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30567 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30568 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30569 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30572 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30574 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30575 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30576 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30577 describes how multiple records are handled.
30579 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30580 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30581 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30583 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30585 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30586 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30587 first. For example:
30589 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30590 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30593 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30594 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30595 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30596 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30597 tested. For example:
30599 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30601 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30602 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30603 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30605 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30607 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30612 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30613 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30616 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30618 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30619 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30621 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30623 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30624 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30625 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30626 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30628 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30629 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30631 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30632 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30634 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30635 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30637 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30638 Consider this example:
30640 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30642 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30645 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30647 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30649 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30650 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30651 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30653 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30658 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30659 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30660 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30661 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30662 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30663 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30665 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30667 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30668 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30669 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30670 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30671 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30672 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30675 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30676 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30677 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30679 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30680 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30683 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30685 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30686 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30688 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30690 for the condition to be true.
30693 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30694 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30696 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30697 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30699 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30701 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30702 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30704 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30705 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30707 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30709 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30710 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30712 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30714 for the condition to be false.
30716 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30717 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30722 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30723 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30724 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30725 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30726 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30727 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30728 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30729 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30730 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30733 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30734 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30735 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30736 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30737 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30738 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30739 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30742 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30743 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30745 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30746 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30748 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30749 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30750 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30751 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30752 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30753 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30755 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30756 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30757 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30759 reject dnslists = \
30760 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30761 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30762 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30763 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30765 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30766 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30767 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30771 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30772 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30773 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30774 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30775 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30776 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30778 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30779 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30781 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30782 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30783 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30785 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30787 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30788 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30790 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30791 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30793 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30794 dnslists = some.list.example
30797 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30798 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30799 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30801 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30804 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30805 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30806 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30807 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30808 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30809 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30810 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30811 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30812 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30813 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30815 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30817 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30818 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30820 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30821 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30822 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30825 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30826 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30827 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30828 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30829 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30830 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30831 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30832 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30833 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30835 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30836 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30837 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30838 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30840 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30841 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30842 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30843 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30844 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30845 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30846 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30847 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30848 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30849 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30851 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30852 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30853 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30856 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30857 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30858 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30859 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30860 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30861 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30863 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30864 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30865 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30866 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30867 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30868 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30869 the &%count=%& option.
30872 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30873 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30874 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30875 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30876 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30878 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30879 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30880 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30881 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30883 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30884 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30885 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30886 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30887 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30888 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30889 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30891 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30892 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30893 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30894 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30895 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30896 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30897 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30899 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30900 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30901 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30902 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30905 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30906 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30907 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30908 multiple different commands.
30910 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30911 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30912 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30913 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30914 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30916 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30919 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30920 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30921 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30922 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30923 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30925 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30926 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30928 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30929 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30930 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30931 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30935 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30936 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30937 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30940 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30941 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30942 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30945 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30946 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30947 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30948 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30949 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30950 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30953 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30954 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30955 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30956 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30957 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30960 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30961 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30962 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30963 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30964 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30965 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30968 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30969 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30970 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30971 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30972 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30973 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30974 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30975 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30976 from getting any email through.
30978 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30979 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30980 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30981 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30982 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30983 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30984 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30985 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30987 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30991 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30992 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30993 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30994 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30995 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30996 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30997 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30998 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30999 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31001 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31002 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31003 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31004 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31005 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31006 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31008 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31009 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31012 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31013 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31014 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31015 required increases with larger limits.
31017 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31018 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31019 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31020 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31021 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31022 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31023 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31024 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31025 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31029 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31030 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31031 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31032 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31033 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31034 message. For example:
31036 # Log all senders' rates
31037 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31038 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31040 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31041 # at the decimal point.
31042 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31043 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31044 $sender_rate_limit }s
31046 # Keep authenticated users under control
31047 deny authenticated = *
31048 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31050 # System-wide rate limit
31051 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31052 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31054 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31055 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31056 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31057 messages per $sender_rate_period
31058 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31059 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31060 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31062 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31063 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31064 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31065 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31066 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31067 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31068 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31072 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31073 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31074 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31075 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31076 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31077 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31078 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31079 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31080 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31082 verify = sender/callout
31083 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31085 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31086 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31087 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31088 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31089 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31090 The available options are as follows:
31093 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31094 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31095 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31097 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31098 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31099 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31100 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31102 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31103 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31105 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31106 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31107 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31108 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31111 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31112 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31113 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31114 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31115 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31116 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31119 warn !verify = sender
31120 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31122 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31123 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31124 verification failure.
31126 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31127 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31130 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31131 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31133 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31135 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31136 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31137 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31139 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31141 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31144 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31145 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31150 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31151 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31152 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31153 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31154 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31155 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31156 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31157 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31158 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31159 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31160 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31161 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31164 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31165 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31166 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31167 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31168 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31169 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31171 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31172 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31173 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31174 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31175 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31177 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31178 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31179 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31180 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31181 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31182 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31183 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31184 supplies a host list.
31185 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31187 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31188 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31189 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31190 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31191 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31192 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31193 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31195 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31196 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31197 following SMTP commands are sent:
31199 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31201 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31204 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31207 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31210 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31211 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31212 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31213 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31214 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31215 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31217 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31218 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31219 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31220 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31221 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31223 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31224 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31225 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31226 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31227 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31232 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31233 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31234 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31235 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31237 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31239 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31240 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31241 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31245 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31246 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31247 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31250 verify = sender/callout=5s
31252 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31253 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31254 the &%connect%& parameter.
31257 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31258 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31259 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31260 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31262 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31264 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31266 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31267 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31268 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31269 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31270 updated in this circumstance.
31272 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31273 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31274 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31275 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31276 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31277 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31280 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31281 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31282 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31283 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31284 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31285 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31286 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31287 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31288 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31289 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31291 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31293 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31296 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31297 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31298 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31301 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31303 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31304 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31305 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31306 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31307 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31310 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31311 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31312 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31313 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31315 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31316 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31317 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31318 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31319 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31320 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31321 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31322 made, until the cache record expires.
31324 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31325 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31326 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31329 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31331 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31332 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31334 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31336 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31337 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31338 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31339 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31343 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31344 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31345 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31346 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31347 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31349 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31351 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31352 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31353 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31354 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31355 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31357 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31358 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31359 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31361 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31363 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31364 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31365 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31366 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31367 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31369 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31370 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31372 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31374 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31375 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31376 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31377 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31378 usefulness of callout caching.
31381 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31383 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31385 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31386 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31387 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31388 when that is used for the connections.
31389 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31390 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31391 if the use_sender option is used,
31392 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31393 and if no other callouts intervene.
31396 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31397 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31398 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31399 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31400 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31401 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31402 these circumstances.
31404 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31405 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31406 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31407 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31408 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31409 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31410 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31412 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31413 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31414 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31415 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31420 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31421 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31422 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31423 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31424 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31425 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31426 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31427 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31428 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31429 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31431 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31432 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31435 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31436 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31437 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31439 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31440 commands up to and including
31444 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31445 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31446 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31447 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31448 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31449 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31450 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31452 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31453 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31454 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31455 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31456 will eventually be noticed.
31458 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31459 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31460 behaviour will be the same.
31464 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31465 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31466 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31467 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31468 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31469 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31472 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31474 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31475 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31476 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31477 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31478 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31479 550 Sender verification failed
31481 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31482 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31483 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31484 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31487 verify = sender/no_details
31490 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31491 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31492 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31493 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31494 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31495 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31496 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31499 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31500 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31501 verification also fails.
31503 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31504 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31507 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31508 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31509 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31512 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31514 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31515 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31516 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31517 verification to succeed.
31519 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31520 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31521 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31522 option. For example:
31524 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31526 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31527 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31529 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31530 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31531 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31532 address and a report is output for each of them.
31536 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31537 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31538 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31539 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31540 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31541 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31542 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31546 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31547 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31548 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31549 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31550 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31551 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31553 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31554 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31555 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31556 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31559 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31561 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31563 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31564 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31566 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31567 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31570 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31571 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31573 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31575 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31576 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31577 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31578 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31581 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31583 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31584 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31585 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31587 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31588 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31589 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31590 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31591 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31592 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31593 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31594 of legitimate HELO domains.
31596 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31597 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31598 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31599 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31602 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31604 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31605 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31606 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31611 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31612 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31613 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31614 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31615 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31616 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31617 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31618 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31620 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31621 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31622 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31623 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31624 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31625 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31626 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31627 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31629 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31630 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31633 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31634 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31637 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31638 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31641 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31642 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31644 recipients = +batv_senders
31646 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31647 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31649 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31650 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31651 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31653 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31654 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31655 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31656 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31657 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31659 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31660 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31661 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31662 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31663 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31664 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31665 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31667 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31668 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31669 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31670 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31674 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31676 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31677 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31678 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31681 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31684 external_smtp_batv:
31686 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31687 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31688 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31689 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31692 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31696 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31697 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31698 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31699 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31700 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31701 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31702 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31703 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31704 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31705 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31707 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31708 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31709 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31710 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31711 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31712 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31714 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31716 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31717 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31718 system to arbitrary domains.
31721 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31722 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31723 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31724 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31727 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31728 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31729 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31731 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31732 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31734 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31735 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31739 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31741 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31742 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31743 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31745 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31749 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31750 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31752 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31753 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31754 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31755 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31756 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31757 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31758 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31762 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31763 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31764 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31765 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31766 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31774 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31775 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31776 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31777 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31778 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31779 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31782 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31783 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31784 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31785 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31786 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31788 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31789 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31790 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31793 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31794 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31796 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31797 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31798 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31800 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31801 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31803 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31806 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31809 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31810 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31811 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31812 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31813 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31814 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31816 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31817 temporarily created in a file called:
31819 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31821 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31822 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31823 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31824 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31825 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31827 control = no_mbox_unspool
31829 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31830 same directory by default.
31834 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31835 .cindex "virus scanning"
31836 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31837 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31838 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31839 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31840 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31841 in memory and thus are much faster.
31843 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31844 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31846 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31847 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31848 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31849 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31851 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31853 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31855 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31857 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31859 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31860 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
31861 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
31865 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31866 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31867 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
31868 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31869 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31870 This scanner type takes one option,
31871 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31872 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31873 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31874 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31875 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
31876 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
31877 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31880 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
31881 If &`pass_unscanned`&
31882 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
31883 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
31889 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31890 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31891 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31893 If you omit the argument, the default path
31894 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31896 If you use a remote host,
31897 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31898 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31899 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31901 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31907 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
31908 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
31909 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
31911 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31912 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31913 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31914 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31915 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31918 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31923 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31924 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31925 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31926 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31927 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31929 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31930 a UNIX socket specification,
31931 a TCP socket specification,
31932 or a (global) option.
31934 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31935 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31936 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31937 and the second a port number,
31938 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31939 These per-server options are supported:
31941 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31944 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31945 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31947 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31951 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31952 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31953 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31954 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31955 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31957 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31959 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31960 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31961 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31962 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31964 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31965 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31966 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31967 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31968 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31969 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31970 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31971 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31972 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31974 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31975 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31976 (Connection refused)
31979 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31980 contributing the code for this scanner.
31983 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31984 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31985 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31986 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31989 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31990 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31993 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31994 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31995 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31996 the &"trigger"& expression.
31999 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32000 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32001 &"name"& expression.
32004 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32006 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32008 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32009 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32010 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32011 configuration setting:
32013 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32014 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32015 found in file:'(.+)'
32018 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32019 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
32021 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32022 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32023 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32024 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32027 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32028 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32030 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32031 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32034 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32035 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32036 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32040 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32042 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32044 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32045 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32046 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32047 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32050 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32052 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32055 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32056 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
32057 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32059 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32061 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32062 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32064 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32065 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32066 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32067 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32068 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32071 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32073 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32076 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32077 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
32078 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
32079 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
32080 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32081 provided that mksd has
32082 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32084 av_scanner = mksd:2
32086 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32089 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32090 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32091 running on the local machine.
32092 There are four options:
32093 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32094 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32095 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32096 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32097 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32100 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32102 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32103 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32104 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32105 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32106 specify an empty element to get this.
32109 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32110 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32111 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
32112 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32113 client communication. For example:
32115 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32117 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32121 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32122 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32125 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32126 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32127 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32128 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32129 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32130 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32133 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32134 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32135 The first element can then be one of
32138 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32139 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32142 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32143 the condition fails immediately.
32145 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32146 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32147 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32148 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32149 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32152 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32153 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32154 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32156 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32157 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32160 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32162 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32164 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32165 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32166 is set to record the actual address used.
32168 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32169 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32170 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32171 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32174 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32175 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32177 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32179 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32182 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32184 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32185 malware = */defer_ok
32187 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32188 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32190 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32192 in the main Exim configuration.
32194 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32195 set acl_m0 = sophie
32198 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32199 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32204 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32205 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32206 .cindex "spam scanning"
32207 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32209 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32210 score and a report for the message.
32211 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32213 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32214 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32215 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
32217 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32219 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32221 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32222 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32225 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32226 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32227 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32228 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32229 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32230 configuration as follows (example):
32232 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32234 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32235 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32236 iptables firewall, consider setting
32237 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32238 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32239 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32240 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32244 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32246 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32248 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32251 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32252 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32253 file name instead of an address/port pair:
32255 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32257 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32258 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32259 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32260 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32262 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32263 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32266 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32267 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32268 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32271 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32272 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32273 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32275 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32276 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32277 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32278 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32280 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32282 The supported options are:
32284 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32285 weight=<value> Selection bias
32286 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32287 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32288 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32289 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32292 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32293 higher values being tried first.
32294 The default priority is 1.
32296 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32297 Within a priority set
32298 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32299 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32301 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32302 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32303 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32304 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32306 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32307 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32309 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32310 The default value is two minutes.
32312 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32313 a failed connect is made.
32314 The default is to not retry.
32316 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32317 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32318 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32321 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32322 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32323 is set to record the actual address used.
32325 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32326 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32328 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32331 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32332 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32333 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32334 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32335 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32338 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32339 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32340 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32341 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32342 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32344 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32345 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32347 or the use of PRDR,
32348 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32349 are needed to use this feature.
32351 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32352 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32353 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32356 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32357 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32358 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32361 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32362 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32366 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32367 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32368 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32369 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32371 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32372 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32374 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32375 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32376 available for use at delivery time.
32379 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32380 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32381 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32383 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32384 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32385 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32386 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32387 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32389 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32390 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32391 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32392 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32393 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32394 spam bar is 50 characters.
32396 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32397 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32398 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32399 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32400 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32401 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32402 unencoded in headers.
32404 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32405 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32406 spam score versus threshold.
32407 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32411 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32412 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32413 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32415 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32416 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32417 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32418 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32419 spam condition, like this:
32421 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32422 spam = joe/defer_ok
32424 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32426 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32429 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32430 warn spam = nobody:true
32431 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32432 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32434 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32435 # is over threshold
32437 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32439 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32440 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32442 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32447 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32448 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32449 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32450 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32451 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32452 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32453 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32454 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32455 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32456 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32459 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32460 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32461 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32462 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32463 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32464 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32465 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32467 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32468 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32469 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32470 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32471 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32473 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32474 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32475 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32476 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32477 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32480 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32482 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32486 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32488 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32489 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32490 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32491 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32493 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32494 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32495 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32496 the full path and file name.
32498 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32499 filename, and the default path is then used.
32501 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32502 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32503 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32505 decode = $mime_filename
32507 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32508 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32509 automatically unlinked.
32511 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32512 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32513 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32514 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32515 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32517 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32518 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32519 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32521 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32522 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32523 available in the MIME ACL:
32526 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32527 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32528 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32529 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32530 contains the empty string.
32532 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32533 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32534 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32540 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32541 case-insensitively.
32543 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32544 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32545 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32546 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32547 only used for display purposes.
32549 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32550 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32551 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32553 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32554 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32555 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32557 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32558 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32559 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32560 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32561 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32563 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32564 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32565 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32566 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32568 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32569 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32570 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32571 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32575 application/octet-stream
32579 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32582 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32583 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32584 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32585 containing the decoded data.
32590 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32591 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32592 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32593 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32596 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32598 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32600 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32601 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32602 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32603 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32605 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32606 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32610 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32613 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32614 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32617 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32618 and the rest are attachments.
32621 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32624 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32625 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32626 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32628 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32629 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32630 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32631 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32633 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32634 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32635 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32636 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32637 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32639 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32640 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32641 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32642 decoding is fully recursive.
32644 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32645 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32646 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32647 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32648 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32649 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32650 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32655 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32656 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32657 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32658 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32659 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32661 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32662 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32663 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32664 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32665 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32667 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32668 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32669 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32670 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32671 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32672 32K characters are checked.
32674 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32675 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32676 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32677 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32678 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32680 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32681 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32683 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32684 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32685 matching regular expression.
32686 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32687 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32689 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32700 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32701 "Local scan function"
32702 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32703 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32704 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32705 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32706 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32708 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32709 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32710 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32711 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32712 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32714 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32715 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32716 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32717 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32719 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32720 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32721 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32722 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32724 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32725 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32726 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32727 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32728 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32729 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32730 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32731 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32732 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32736 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32737 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32738 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32739 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32740 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32741 directory, so you might set
32743 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32745 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32746 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32747 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32748 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32749 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32750 _src/local_scan.c_.
32752 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32753 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32755 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32757 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32762 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32763 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32764 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32766 #include "local_scan.h"
32768 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32769 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32770 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32771 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32772 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32773 strings and pointers to character strings:
32775 #define CS (char *)
32776 #define CCS (const char *)
32777 #define CSS (char **)
32778 #define US (unsigned char *)
32779 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32780 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32782 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32784 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32786 The arguments are as follows:
32789 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32790 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32791 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32793 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32794 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32795 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32796 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32797 case this changes in some future version.
32799 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32800 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32803 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32806 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32807 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32808 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32809 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32810 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32811 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32813 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32814 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32815 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32817 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32818 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32819 queued without immediate delivery.
32821 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32822 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32823 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32824 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32825 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32828 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32829 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32830 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32833 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32834 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32835 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32836 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32837 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32838 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32839 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32841 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32842 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32843 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32846 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32847 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32848 &%-oe%& command line options.
32852 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32853 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32854 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32855 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32856 want to do this, you must have the line
32858 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32860 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32861 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32862 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32865 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32866 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32867 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32868 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32869 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32870 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32872 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32873 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32875 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32876 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32877 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32880 int local_scan_options_count =
32881 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32883 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32884 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32888 my_string = some string of text...
32890 The available types of option data are as follows:
32893 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32894 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32895 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32896 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32897 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32898 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32901 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32902 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32903 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32904 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32907 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32908 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32911 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32912 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32913 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32914 printed with the suffix K or M.
32916 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32917 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32918 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32919 always output in octal.
32921 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32922 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32923 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32925 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32926 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32927 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32930 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32931 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32935 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32936 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32937 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32938 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32939 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32940 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32941 C variables are as follows:
32944 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32945 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32946 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32948 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32949 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32950 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32952 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32953 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32954 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32955 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32958 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32959 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32960 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32963 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32964 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32968 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32969 selected, you should use code like this:
32971 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32972 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32974 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32975 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32976 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32978 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32979 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32982 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32983 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32985 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32986 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32988 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32989 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32990 &%-bh%& command line option.
32992 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32993 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32994 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32996 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32997 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32998 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32999 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33001 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33002 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33003 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33005 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33006 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33008 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33009 The number of accepted recipients.
33011 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33012 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33013 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33014 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33015 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33016 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33017 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33018 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33019 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33020 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33021 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33022 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33024 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33025 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33027 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33028 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33029 locally-submitted messages.
33031 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33032 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33033 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33035 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33036 The name of the sending host, if known.
33038 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33039 The port on the sending host.
33041 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33042 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33044 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33045 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33047 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33048 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33049 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33053 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33054 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33055 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33056 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33061 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33062 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33064 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33065 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33066 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33067 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33068 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33069 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33070 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33072 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33073 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33076 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33077 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33078 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33083 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33084 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33087 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33088 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33090 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33091 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33092 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33093 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33095 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33096 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33097 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33098 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33099 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33100 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33101 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33102 is NULL for all recipients.
33107 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33108 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33109 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33110 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33114 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33115 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33117 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33118 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33119 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33120 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33122 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33123 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33124 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33125 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33126 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33128 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33130 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33131 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33132 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33133 return value is as follows:
33138 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33144 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33150 The process timed out.
33154 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33157 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33158 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33159 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33160 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33161 forks a subprocess that is running
33163 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33165 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33166 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33167 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33168 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33170 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33171 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33172 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33173 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33176 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33177 *sender_authentication)*&
33178 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33181 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33183 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33186 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33187 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33188 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33189 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33190 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33192 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33193 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33196 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33197 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33198 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33199 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33200 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33201 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33202 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33203 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33205 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33206 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33207 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33208 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33209 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33210 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33212 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33213 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33214 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33215 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33217 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33218 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33219 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33220 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33221 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33222 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33223 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33224 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33225 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33226 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33228 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33229 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33231 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33232 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33235 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33236 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33237 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33238 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33239 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33242 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33243 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33244 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33245 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33246 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33247 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33249 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33251 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33252 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33253 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33254 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33255 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33258 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33259 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33260 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33261 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33262 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33263 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33264 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33265 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33267 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33268 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33269 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33271 &`OK `& match succeeded
33272 &`FAIL `& match failed
33273 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33275 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33276 inability to contact a database.
33278 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33280 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33281 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33282 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33284 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33286 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33287 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33288 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33290 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33292 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33295 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33297 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33298 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33299 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33300 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33301 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33302 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33305 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33307 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33308 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33309 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33310 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33311 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33312 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33315 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33316 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33317 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33318 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33320 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33321 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33322 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33323 value afterwards. For example:
33325 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33326 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33327 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33330 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33331 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33332 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33333 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33340 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33341 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33342 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33343 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33344 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33345 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33346 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33347 binary string is returned with an error message.
33349 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33350 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33351 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33353 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33354 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33355 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33356 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33357 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33359 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33360 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33361 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33363 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33364 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33365 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33366 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33370 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33371 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33374 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33375 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33376 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33377 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33378 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33379 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33380 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33381 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33384 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33385 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33387 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33388 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33389 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33390 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33391 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33392 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33393 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33395 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33396 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33398 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33399 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33400 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33401 multiple output lines.
33403 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33404 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33405 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33406 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33407 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33408 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33409 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33412 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33413 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33414 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33415 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33417 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33418 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33419 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33421 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33424 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33427 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33428 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33429 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33430 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33431 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33432 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33438 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33439 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33440 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33441 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33442 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33443 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33444 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33447 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33448 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33449 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33450 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33452 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33453 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33455 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33457 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33458 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33459 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33460 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33462 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33463 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33464 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33465 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33473 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33475 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33476 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33477 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33478 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33479 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33480 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33481 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33482 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33484 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33485 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33486 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33487 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33488 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33490 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33491 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33492 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33493 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33494 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33495 prevent it happening on retries.
33497 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33498 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33499 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33500 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33501 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33502 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33503 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33504 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33507 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33508 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33509 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33510 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33511 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33512 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33513 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33515 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33516 system_filter_user = exim
33518 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33519 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33520 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33521 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33522 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33523 by the &%reply%& command.
33526 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33527 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33528 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33529 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33531 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33532 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33536 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33537 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33538 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33539 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33540 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33541 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33544 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33545 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33546 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33547 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33548 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33549 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33550 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33552 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33553 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33554 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33555 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33556 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33558 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33559 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33560 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33561 to which users' filter files can refer.
33565 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33566 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33567 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33568 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33569 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33573 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33574 .cindex "freezing messages"
33575 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33576 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33577 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33578 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33579 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33580 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33581 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33582 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33583 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33584 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33586 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33588 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33590 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33591 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33592 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33593 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33594 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33597 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33598 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33599 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33600 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33602 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33603 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33604 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33605 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33606 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33607 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33608 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33609 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33610 message. For example:
33612 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33613 because it contains attachments that we are \
33614 not prepared to receive."
33617 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33618 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33619 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33620 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33621 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33622 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33625 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33626 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33628 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33629 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33630 generated by the filter.
33632 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33634 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33635 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33641 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33642 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33647 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33648 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33649 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33650 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33651 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33653 headers add <string>
33654 headers remove <string>
33656 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33657 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33658 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33659 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33660 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33662 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33663 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33664 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33667 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33668 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33671 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33672 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33673 space after input continuations is ignored.
33675 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33676 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33677 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33678 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33679 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33681 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33682 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33683 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33684 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33685 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33686 used for all recipients of the message.
33688 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33689 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33690 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33691 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33692 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33693 until the message is actually being written (see section
33694 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33696 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33697 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33698 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33699 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33700 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33701 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33702 modified more than once.
33704 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33705 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33708 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33709 headers remove "Subject"
33710 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33711 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33716 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33717 .cindex "envelope sender"
33718 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33720 errors_to <some address>
33722 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33723 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33724 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33727 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33729 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33730 address if its delivery failed.
33734 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33735 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33736 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33737 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33738 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33739 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33740 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33741 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33742 which implements such a filter:
33747 domains = +local_domains
33748 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33753 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33754 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33755 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33756 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33758 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33759 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33760 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33761 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33763 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33764 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33765 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33773 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33775 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33776 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33777 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33778 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33779 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33780 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33781 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33782 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33784 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33785 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33786 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33787 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33788 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33790 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33791 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33792 loopback interface specially in any way.
33794 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33795 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33800 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33801 .cindex "message" "submission"
33802 .cindex "submission mode"
33803 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33804 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33805 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33806 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33808 control = submission
33810 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33811 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33812 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33813 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33814 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33815 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33817 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33818 control = submission
33820 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33821 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33822 is used to separate options. For example:
33824 control = submission/sender_retain
33826 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33827 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33828 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33829 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33830 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33831 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33832 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33834 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33835 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33838 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33840 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33841 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33842 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33843 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33845 accept authenticated = *
33846 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33847 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33848 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33850 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33851 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33852 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33854 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33856 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33859 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33861 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33862 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33863 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33864 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33866 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33867 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33868 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33869 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33870 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33871 spoof another's address.
33873 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33874 .cindex "line endings"
33875 .cindex "carriage return"
33877 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33878 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33879 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33880 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33881 use CRLF or just CR.
33883 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33884 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33885 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33886 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33887 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33888 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33889 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33890 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33894 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33896 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33899 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33900 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33903 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33904 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33905 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33906 people trying to play silly games.
33908 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33909 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33917 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33918 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33919 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33920 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33921 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33922 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33923 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33924 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33926 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33927 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33928 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33929 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33930 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33932 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33933 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33934 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33935 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33936 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33937 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33938 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33939 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33944 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33945 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33946 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33947 .cindex "sender" "address"
33948 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33949 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33950 .cindex "envelope sender"
33951 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33952 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33953 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33954 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33956 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33957 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33959 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33960 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33961 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33962 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33963 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33964 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33965 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33966 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33967 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33969 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33970 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33971 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33972 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33973 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33974 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33975 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33977 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33978 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33979 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33981 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33982 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33983 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33984 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33988 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33989 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33990 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33991 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33992 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33993 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33994 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33995 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33998 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33999 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34002 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34003 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34007 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34008 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34010 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34011 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34012 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34014 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34017 For a locally-submitted message,
34018 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34019 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34020 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34021 included in log lines in this case.
34023 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34024 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34030 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34031 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34032 includes the header line:
34034 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34037 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34038 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34039 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34040 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34041 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34042 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34045 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34046 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34047 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34048 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34049 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34050 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34052 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34053 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34054 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34055 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34056 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34057 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34058 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34059 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34063 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34064 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34065 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34066 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34067 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34068 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34069 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34070 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34071 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34075 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34076 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34077 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34078 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34079 .cindex "message" "submission"
34080 .cindex "submission mode"
34081 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34082 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34085 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34086 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34088 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34089 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34091 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34092 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34093 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34095 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34096 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34098 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34099 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34103 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34105 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34106 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34107 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34108 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34109 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34110 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34111 &%qualify_domain%&.
34113 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34114 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34115 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34116 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34119 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34120 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34121 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34122 .cindex "message" "submission"
34123 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34124 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34125 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34126 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34127 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34128 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34129 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34130 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34131 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34132 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34135 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34136 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34137 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34138 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34139 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34140 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34142 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34143 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34144 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34145 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34147 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34148 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34149 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34152 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34153 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34154 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34155 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34156 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34157 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34158 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34159 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34160 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34161 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34162 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34163 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34167 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34168 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34169 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34170 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34171 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34172 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34173 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34174 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34175 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34179 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34180 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34181 .cindex "message" "submission"
34182 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34183 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34184 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34185 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34186 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34189 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34190 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34191 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34192 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34193 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34194 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34195 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34196 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34197 line is added to the message.
34199 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34200 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34201 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34202 options true at the same time.
34204 .cindex "submission mode"
34205 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34206 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34207 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34208 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34210 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34211 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34212 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34213 created as follows:
34216 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34217 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34218 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34220 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34221 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34223 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34224 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34227 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34228 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34229 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34230 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34232 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34233 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34234 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34235 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34239 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34240 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34241 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34242 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34243 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34244 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34245 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34246 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34247 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34249 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34250 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34251 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34252 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34253 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34254 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34256 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34257 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34258 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34260 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34261 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34262 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34264 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34265 X-added-second: another added header line
34267 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34269 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34270 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34271 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34273 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34274 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34275 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34276 not part of the names. For example:
34278 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34281 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34282 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34283 Each item is separately expanded.
34284 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34285 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34286 will act as list separators.
34288 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34289 items are expanded at routing time,
34290 and then associated with all addresses that are
34291 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34292 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34293 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34296 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34297 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34298 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34300 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34301 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34302 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34305 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34306 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34307 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34308 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34309 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34310 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34311 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34313 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34314 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34315 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34316 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34318 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34319 the following consequences:
34322 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34323 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34324 to it, at all times.
34326 Header lines that are added by a router's
34327 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34328 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34330 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34331 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34333 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34334 a later router or by a transport.
34336 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34337 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34339 headers_remove = subject
34340 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34344 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34345 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34351 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34352 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34353 .cindex "constructed address"
34354 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34357 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34361 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34363 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34364 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34365 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34366 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34367 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34368 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34369 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34370 there is no password file entry.
34373 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34374 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34375 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34376 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34377 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34378 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34379 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34380 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34384 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34385 .cindex "case of local parts"
34386 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34387 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34388 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34389 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34390 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34391 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34392 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34395 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34396 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34397 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34398 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34399 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34403 domains = +local_domains
34404 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34405 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34408 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34409 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34410 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34411 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34412 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34416 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34417 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34418 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34419 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34420 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34421 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34422 empty components for compatibility.
34426 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34427 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34428 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34429 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34430 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34431 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34433 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34434 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34435 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34436 example, a header such as
34440 might get rewritten as
34442 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34444 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34445 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34448 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34449 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34450 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34451 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34452 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34453 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34454 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34459 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34461 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34462 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34463 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34464 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34465 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34466 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34467 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34470 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34472 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34474 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34477 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34480 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34482 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34485 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34488 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34489 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34492 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34493 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34494 used to contain the envelope information.
34498 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34499 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34500 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34501 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34502 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34505 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34506 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34507 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34508 processing is the same in both cases.
34510 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34511 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34512 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34513 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34514 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34515 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34516 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34517 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34520 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34521 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34522 required for the transaction.
34524 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34525 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34526 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34527 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34528 is called for verification.
34530 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34531 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34532 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34534 .cindex "carriage return"
34536 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34537 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34538 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34541 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34542 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34543 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34544 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34545 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34546 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34547 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34548 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34549 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34551 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34552 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34553 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34554 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34556 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34557 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34558 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34559 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34561 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34562 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34563 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34564 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34565 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34566 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34567 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34568 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34569 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34570 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34572 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34573 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34575 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34576 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34577 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34578 square bracket of the IP address.
34583 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34584 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34585 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34586 .cindex "host" "error"
34587 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34588 message errors, and recipient errors.
34591 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34592 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34593 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34596 Connection refused or timed out,
34598 Any error response code on connection,
34600 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34602 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34604 I/O errors at any time,
34606 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34607 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34610 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34611 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34612 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34613 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34614 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34615 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34616 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34617 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34619 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34620 .cindex "message" "error"
34621 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34622 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34623 message errors are:
34626 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34629 Timeout after MAIL,
34631 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34632 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34633 connection at any other time.
34636 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34637 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34638 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34639 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34640 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34641 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34642 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34643 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34644 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34645 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34647 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34648 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34649 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34652 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34653 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34654 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34655 recipient errors are:
34658 Any error response to RCPT,
34660 Timeout after RCPT.
34663 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34664 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34665 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34666 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34667 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34668 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34669 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34670 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34671 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34672 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34673 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34674 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34675 the retry clock is reset.
34677 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34678 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34679 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34680 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34681 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34682 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34683 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34684 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34685 recipient's retry time.
34688 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34689 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34690 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34691 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34692 until the next delivery attempt.
34694 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34695 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34696 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34697 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34698 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34701 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34702 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34703 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34704 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34705 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34706 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34707 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34709 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34710 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34711 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34712 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34713 then to be treated as a host error.
34715 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34716 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34717 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34718 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34719 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34724 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34725 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34726 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34729 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34730 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34731 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34733 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34735 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34736 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34737 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34738 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34739 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34740 stream and exits with an error code.
34742 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34743 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34744 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34745 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34747 .cindex "carriage return"
34749 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34750 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34751 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34753 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34754 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34755 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34757 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34758 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34759 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34760 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34761 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34762 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34763 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34764 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34766 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34767 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34768 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34769 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34770 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34771 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34772 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34773 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34774 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34776 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34777 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34778 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34780 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34781 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34782 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34783 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34784 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34786 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34787 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34788 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34789 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34790 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34791 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34792 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34794 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34795 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34796 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34797 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34798 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34800 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34801 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34802 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34803 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34804 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34805 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34806 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34807 a delivery process.
34809 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34810 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34811 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34812 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34813 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34815 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34816 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34817 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34818 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34820 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34821 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34822 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34826 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34827 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34828 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34829 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34830 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34831 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34832 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34833 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34836 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34837 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34838 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34839 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34840 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34841 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34842 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34843 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34844 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34845 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34846 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34850 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34851 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34852 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34853 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34854 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34855 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34856 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34857 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34859 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34860 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34861 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34862 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34863 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34866 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34867 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34868 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34870 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34871 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34872 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34873 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34874 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34879 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34880 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34881 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34882 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34884 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34885 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34886 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34887 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34888 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34889 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34890 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34891 SMTP response codes.
34893 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34894 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34895 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34896 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34897 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34898 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34899 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34900 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34905 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34906 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34907 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34908 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34909 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34910 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34911 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34913 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34914 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34915 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34916 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34917 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34918 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34919 argument. For example,
34927 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34928 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34929 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34930 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34931 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34933 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34934 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34935 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34936 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34937 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34938 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34939 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34940 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34942 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34943 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34944 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34945 whatever the form of its argument. For
34948 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34949 $sender_host_address
34951 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34952 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34953 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34954 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34955 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34956 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34957 for it to change them before running the command.
34961 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34962 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34963 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34964 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34965 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34966 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34967 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34968 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34969 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34970 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34971 runs for RCPT commands:
34975 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34979 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34980 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34981 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34982 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34983 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34984 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34985 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34986 envelope along with the message.
34988 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34989 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34990 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34991 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34992 can be used to specify it.
34994 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34995 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34996 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34997 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34998 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35001 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35002 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35003 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35008 driver = manualroute
35009 transport = smtp_appendfile
35010 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35014 driver = appendfile
35015 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35020 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35021 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35022 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35026 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35027 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35028 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35029 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35030 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35031 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35032 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35033 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35034 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35035 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35037 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35038 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35040 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35041 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35042 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35043 make some use of automatically, for example:
35045 554 Unexpected end of file
35046 Transaction started in line 10
35047 Error detected in line 14
35049 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35052 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35053 The error message was:
35055 501 '>' missing at end of address
35057 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35058 The error was detected in line 12.
35059 The SMTP command at fault was:
35061 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35063 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35064 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35066 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35067 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35069 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35070 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35074 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35075 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35077 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35078 "Customizing messages"
35079 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35080 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35081 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35082 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35083 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35085 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35086 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35087 option. Exim also adds the line
35089 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35091 to all warning and bounce messages,
35094 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35095 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35096 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35097 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35098 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35099 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35100 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35102 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35103 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35104 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35105 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35106 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35109 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35110 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35111 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35112 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35113 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35114 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35115 option, rounded to a whole number.
35117 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35120 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35121 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35123 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35124 failing addresses with their error messages.
35126 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35127 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35129 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35130 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35133 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35134 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35135 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35137 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35138 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35139 {: returning message to sender}}
35141 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35143 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35144 {that you sent }{sent by
35148 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35149 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35151 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35153 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35156 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35158 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35161 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35162 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35163 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35164 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35165 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35169 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35170 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35172 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35173 the delayed addresses.
35175 The third item then ends the message.
35178 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35179 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35181 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35182 $warn_message_delay
35184 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35186 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35187 {that you sent }{sent by
35191 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35192 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35194 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35195 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35196 The date of the message is: $h_date
35198 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35200 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35201 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35202 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35203 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35204 the message will be returned to you.
35206 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35207 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35208 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35209 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35210 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35211 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35212 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35213 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35222 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35223 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35224 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35228 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35229 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35230 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35231 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35232 routing explicitly:
35234 send_to_smart_host:
35235 driver = manualroute
35236 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35237 transport = remote_smtp
35239 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35240 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35241 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35242 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35243 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35248 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35249 .cindex "mailing lists"
35250 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35251 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35252 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35254 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35255 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35256 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35257 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35261 domains = lists.example
35262 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35265 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35268 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35269 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35270 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35271 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35273 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35274 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35277 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35278 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35279 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35280 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35281 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35283 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35284 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35285 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35286 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35287 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35288 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35289 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35290 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35291 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35295 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35296 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35297 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35298 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35299 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35300 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35301 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35303 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35304 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35305 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35306 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35307 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35311 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35312 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35313 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35314 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35315 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35316 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35317 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35318 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35319 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35320 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35322 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35323 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35324 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35325 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35326 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35327 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35328 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35329 pre-existing messages.
35331 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35332 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35333 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35334 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35335 one level of expansion anyway.
35339 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35340 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35341 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35342 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35343 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35344 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35346 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35347 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35351 domains = lists.example
35352 local_part_suffix = -request
35353 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35358 domains = lists.example
35359 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35360 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35361 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35364 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35369 domains = lists.example
35371 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35373 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35374 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35375 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35378 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35379 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35380 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35381 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35382 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35383 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35384 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35385 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35386 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35388 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35389 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35390 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35395 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35397 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35398 .cindex "envelope sender"
35399 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35400 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35401 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35402 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35403 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35404 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35406 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35407 .oindex &%return_path%&
35408 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35409 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35410 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35411 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35412 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35413 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35414 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35420 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35421 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35423 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35424 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35425 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35426 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35427 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35428 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35429 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35432 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35434 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35435 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35436 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35437 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35438 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35439 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35441 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35442 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35443 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35444 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35448 domains = ! +local_domains
35450 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35451 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35454 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35455 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35456 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35457 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35460 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35461 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35462 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35463 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35464 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35468 domains = ! +local_domains
35469 transport = remote_smtp
35471 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35472 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35475 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35476 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35477 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35478 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35481 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35482 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35483 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35484 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35485 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35486 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35494 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35495 .cindex "virtual domains"
35496 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35497 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35501 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35502 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35503 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35505 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35506 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35507 have login accounts on that host.
35510 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35511 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35512 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35513 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35514 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35515 to a router of this form:
35519 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35520 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35523 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35524 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35525 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35526 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35527 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35528 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35530 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35531 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35532 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35533 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35535 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35536 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35537 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35541 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35542 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35543 transport = my_mailboxes
35545 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35546 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35547 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35548 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35549 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35553 driver = appendfile
35554 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35557 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35558 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35560 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35561 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35562 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35563 information about the domains.
35567 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35568 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35569 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35570 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35571 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35572 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35573 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35574 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35575 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35576 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35577 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35578 example, consider this router:
35583 file = $home/.forward
35584 local_part_suffix = -*
35585 local_part_suffix_optional
35588 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35589 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35590 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35591 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35593 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35594 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35597 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35598 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35599 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35600 control over which suffixes are valid.
35602 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35603 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35609 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35610 local_part_suffix = -*
35611 local_part_suffix_optional
35614 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35615 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35616 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35617 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35618 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35622 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35623 .cindex "vacation processing"
35624 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35625 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35626 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35627 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35628 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35631 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35632 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35633 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35634 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35636 spqr, vacation-spqr
35639 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35640 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35641 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35642 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35643 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35647 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35648 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35652 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35653 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35654 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35655 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35656 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35657 each day's messages.
35659 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35660 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35661 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35662 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35666 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35667 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35668 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35669 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35670 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35671 permanently connected.
35673 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35674 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35675 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35678 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35679 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35680 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35681 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35682 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35683 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35684 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35685 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35687 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35688 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35689 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35690 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35691 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35692 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35695 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35696 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35697 intermittent host. For example:
35699 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35701 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35702 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35703 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35704 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35705 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35706 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35709 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35710 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35711 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35712 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35713 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35714 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35715 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35719 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35720 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35721 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35722 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35723 delivered immediately.
35725 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35726 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35727 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35728 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35729 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35730 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35731 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35732 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35733 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35734 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35735 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35736 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35737 single SMTP connection.
35741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35744 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35745 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35746 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35747 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35748 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35749 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35750 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35751 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35752 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35753 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35756 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35757 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35758 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35759 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35760 email is not desirable.
35762 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35763 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35764 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35765 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35766 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35767 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35768 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35770 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35771 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35772 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35773 before sending a message to the smart host.
35775 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35776 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35777 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35779 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35780 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35781 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35782 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35783 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35784 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35785 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35787 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35791 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35792 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35794 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35795 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35796 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35797 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35798 successful, a zero return code is given.
35800 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35801 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35802 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35803 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35804 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35807 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35808 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35809 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35811 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35812 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35813 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35814 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35815 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35817 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35818 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35819 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35821 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35822 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35823 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35824 are ever generated.
35826 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35828 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35829 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35830 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35833 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35834 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35835 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35836 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35837 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35838 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35846 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35847 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35848 .cindex "log" "types of"
35849 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35854 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35855 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35856 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35857 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35858 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35859 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35860 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35861 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35863 .cindex "reject log"
35864 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35865 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35866 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35867 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35868 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35869 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35870 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35871 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35872 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35875 .cindex "panic log"
35876 .cindex "system log"
35877 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35878 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35879 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35880 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35881 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35882 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35883 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35884 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35885 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35888 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35889 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35890 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35892 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35895 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35896 ways of changing this:
35899 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35904 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35906 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35909 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35913 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35914 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35915 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35916 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35917 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35918 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35923 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35924 .cindex "log" "destination"
35925 .cindex "log" "to file"
35926 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35928 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35929 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35930 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35931 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35932 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35933 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35934 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35936 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35937 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35938 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35939 references to the host name:
35941 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35943 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35944 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35945 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35946 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35947 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35950 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35951 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35952 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35953 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35954 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35955 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35956 implying the use of a default path.
35958 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35959 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35960 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35961 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35962 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35963 equivalent to the setting:
35965 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35967 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35968 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35969 that is where the logs are written.
35971 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35972 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35974 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35976 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35977 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35978 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35979 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35981 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35986 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35987 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35988 .cindex "cycling logs"
35989 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35990 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35991 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35992 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35993 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35994 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35995 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35997 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35998 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35999 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36000 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36001 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36002 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36003 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36004 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36005 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36006 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36007 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36012 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36013 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36014 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36015 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36016 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36017 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36018 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36019 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36021 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36022 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36023 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36024 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36026 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36027 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36029 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36030 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36031 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36032 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36034 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36035 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36036 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36037 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36039 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36040 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36041 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36042 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36043 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36044 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36047 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36048 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36049 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36050 /var/log/exim/panic
36054 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36055 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36056 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36057 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36058 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36059 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36060 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36061 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36062 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36063 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36064 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36065 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36066 the time and host name to each line.
36067 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36070 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36072 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36074 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36077 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36078 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36079 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36080 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36082 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36083 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36084 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36085 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36086 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36087 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36088 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36089 RFC 3164, you should set
36091 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36093 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36094 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36096 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36097 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36098 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36099 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36100 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36101 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36102 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36103 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36104 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36106 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36107 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36108 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36109 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36112 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36115 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36116 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36117 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36118 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36120 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36121 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36122 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36123 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36124 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36125 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36127 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36128 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36129 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36132 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36134 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36135 without modification.
36137 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36138 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36139 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36144 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36145 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36146 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36147 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36148 timestamp. The flags are:
36150 &`<=`& message arrival
36151 &`(=`& message fakereject
36152 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36153 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36154 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36155 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36156 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36157 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36161 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36162 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36163 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36164 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36165 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36167 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36168 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36169 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36171 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36172 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36173 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36177 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36181 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36182 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36183 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36184 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36185 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36186 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36187 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36188 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36189 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36190 name in parentheses.
36192 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36193 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36194 the log containing text like these examples:
36196 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36197 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36199 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36202 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36203 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36206 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36207 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36208 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36209 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36210 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36211 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36212 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36213 suite that was used.
36215 .cindex log protocol
36216 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36217 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36218 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36219 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36220 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36221 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36222 authenticator name.
36224 .cindex "size" "of message"
36225 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36226 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36227 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36228 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36231 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36232 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36236 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36237 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36238 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36239 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36240 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36241 to fit it on the page:
36243 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36244 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36245 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36246 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36247 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36249 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36250 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36251 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36252 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36253 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36255 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36256 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36257 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36258 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36260 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36261 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36263 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36265 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36266 parentheses afterwards.
36268 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36269 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36270 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36271 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36272 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36273 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36274 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36275 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36276 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36277 TLS cipher information is still available.
36279 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36280 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36281 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36282 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36283 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36285 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36286 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36288 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36289 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36292 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36293 .cindex "discarded messages"
36294 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36295 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36296 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36297 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36299 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36300 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36302 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36303 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36305 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36306 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36310 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36311 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36313 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36314 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36316 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36317 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36318 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36320 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36321 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36323 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36324 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36325 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36329 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36330 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36331 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36332 following form is logged:
36334 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36335 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36337 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36338 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36340 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36341 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36342 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36343 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36344 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36346 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36347 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36348 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36349 flagged with &`**`&.
36353 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36354 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36355 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36356 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36357 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36361 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36364 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36366 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36367 at the end of its processing.
36372 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36373 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36374 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36375 the following table:
36377 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36378 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36379 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36380 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36381 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36382 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36383 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36384 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36385 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36386 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36387 &`H `& host name and IP address
36388 &`I `& local interface used
36389 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36390 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36391 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36392 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36393 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36394 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36395 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36396 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36397 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36398 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36399 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36400 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36401 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36402 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36403 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36404 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36405 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36406 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36407 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36408 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36409 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36413 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36414 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36415 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36418 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36419 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36420 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36421 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36422 during the first delivery attempt.
36424 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36425 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36426 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36428 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36429 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36430 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36431 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36432 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36435 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36436 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36439 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36440 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36442 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36443 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36445 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36446 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36447 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36451 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36455 .cindex DKIM "log line"
36456 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36457 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36465 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36466 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36467 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36468 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36469 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36472 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36474 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36475 selection marked by asterisks:
36477 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36478 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36479 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36480 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36481 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36482 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36483 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36484 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36485 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36486 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36487 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36488 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36489 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36490 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36491 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36492 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36493 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36494 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36495 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36496 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36497 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36498 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36499 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36500 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36501 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36502 &` pid `& Exim process id
36503 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36504 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36505 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36506 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36507 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36508 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36509 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36510 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36511 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36512 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36513 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36514 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36515 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36516 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36517 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36518 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36519 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36520 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36521 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36522 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36523 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36524 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36525 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36527 &` all `& all of the above
36529 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36530 section &<<SECID99>>&
36532 More details on each of these items follows:
36536 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36537 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36538 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36539 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36540 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36541 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36543 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36544 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36545 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36546 this log selector is set.
36548 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36549 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36550 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36551 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36552 such users cannot access the log).
36554 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36555 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36556 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36557 parentheses between them.
36559 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36560 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36561 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36562 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36563 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36564 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36565 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36566 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36567 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36568 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36569 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36570 between the caller and Exim.
36572 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36573 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36574 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36576 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36577 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36578 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36579 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36580 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36581 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36583 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36584 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36585 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36586 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36587 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36589 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36590 .cindex "size" "of message"
36591 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36592 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36595 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36596 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36597 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36598 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36600 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36601 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36602 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36605 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36606 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36607 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36608 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36609 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36612 .cindex dnssec logging
36613 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36614 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36615 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36616 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36617 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36619 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36620 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36621 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36622 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36623 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36624 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36626 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36627 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36628 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36629 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36630 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36632 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36633 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36634 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36635 client's ident port times out.
36637 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36638 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36639 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36640 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36641 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36642 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36643 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36644 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36645 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36646 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36647 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36649 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36650 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36651 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36652 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36653 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36654 on a proxied connection
36655 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36656 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36658 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36659 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36660 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36661 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36662 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36663 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36664 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36665 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36666 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36667 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36668 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36670 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36671 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36672 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36674 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36675 .cindex millisecond logging
36676 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36677 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36678 appended to the seconds value.
36680 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36681 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36682 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36683 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36684 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36685 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36686 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36687 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36688 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36690 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36691 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36692 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36693 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36694 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36695 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36696 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36697 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36698 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36699 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36701 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36702 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36703 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36704 immediately after the time and date.
36706 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36707 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36708 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36710 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36711 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36712 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36713 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36714 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36715 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36716 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36717 message has been successfully received.
36718 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36719 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36721 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36722 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36723 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36724 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36727 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
36728 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36729 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36730 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36731 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36734 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36735 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36736 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36737 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36738 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36740 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36743 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36744 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36745 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36746 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36748 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36749 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36750 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36751 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36752 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36754 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36755 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36756 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36757 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36760 .cindex "log" "return path"
36761 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36762 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36763 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36764 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36766 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36767 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36768 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36769 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36770 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36772 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36773 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36774 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36775 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36778 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36779 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36782 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36783 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36784 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36785 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36787 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36788 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36790 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36791 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36792 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36793 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36794 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36795 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36798 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36799 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36800 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36801 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36802 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36803 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36804 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36805 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36806 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36807 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36809 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36810 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36811 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36812 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36813 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36814 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36815 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36816 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36818 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36819 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36820 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36821 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36822 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36823 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36825 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36826 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36827 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36828 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36829 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36830 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36831 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36832 already have their own log lines.
36834 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36835 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36836 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36837 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36838 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36839 the same logging options.
36841 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36842 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36846 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36847 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36848 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36849 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36850 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36852 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36853 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36854 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36855 was accepted or used.
36857 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36858 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36859 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36860 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36861 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36862 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36863 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36864 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36866 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36867 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36868 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36869 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36870 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36871 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36872 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36873 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36874 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36876 .cindex "log" "subject"
36877 .cindex "subject, logging"
36878 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36879 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36880 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36881 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36882 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36884 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36886 .cindex DANE logging
36887 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36888 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36891 using a CA trust anchor,
36892 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
36894 and &`CV=no`& if not.
36896 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36897 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36898 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36899 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36901 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36902 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36903 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36904 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36905 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36907 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36908 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36909 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36910 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36911 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36913 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36914 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36915 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36919 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36920 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36921 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36922 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36923 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36924 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36925 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36926 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36927 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36928 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36929 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36930 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36931 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36933 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36934 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36935 &%message_logs%& option false.
36941 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36942 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36944 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36945 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36946 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36947 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36948 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36950 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36951 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36952 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36953 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36954 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36955 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36956 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36958 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36959 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36960 "extract statistics from the log"
36961 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36962 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36963 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36964 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36965 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36966 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36967 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36968 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36971 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36972 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36973 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36978 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36979 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36980 .cindex "process, querying"
36982 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36983 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36984 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36985 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36986 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36987 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36988 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36989 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36991 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36992 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36993 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36996 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36997 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36998 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36999 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37000 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37003 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37004 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37005 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37006 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37008 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37010 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37011 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37012 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37013 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37014 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37015 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37017 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37018 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37022 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37023 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37024 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37025 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37029 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37033 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37034 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37036 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37037 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37040 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37041 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37042 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37046 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37047 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37048 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37050 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37051 Match against the size field.
37053 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37054 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37056 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37057 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37060 Match only frozen messages.
37063 Match only non-frozen messages.
37066 The following options control the format of the output:
37070 Display only the count of matching messages.
37073 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37077 Display message ids only.
37080 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37083 Display messages in reverse order.
37086 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37089 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37093 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37094 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37095 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37096 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37097 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37098 running a command such as
37100 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37102 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37103 it, as in the following example:
37105 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37107 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37108 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37109 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37110 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37112 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37113 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37114 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37115 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37116 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37117 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37120 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37121 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37122 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37123 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37124 level"& addresses).
37129 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37131 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37132 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37133 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37134 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37135 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37136 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37137 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37138 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37139 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37140 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37142 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37144 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37146 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37147 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37148 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37150 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37151 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37152 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37153 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37154 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37156 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37157 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37158 regular expression.
37160 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37161 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37163 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37164 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37168 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37169 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37170 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37171 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37172 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37173 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37176 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37177 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37178 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37179 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37180 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37183 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37184 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37185 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37186 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37187 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37188 the &%--help%& option.
37191 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37192 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37193 .cindex "cycling logs"
37194 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37195 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37196 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37197 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37198 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37199 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37200 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37202 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37203 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37205 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37206 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37207 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37211 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37212 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37213 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37214 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37215 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37216 logs are handled similarly.
37218 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37219 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37220 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37221 any existing log files.
37223 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37224 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37225 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37226 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37227 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37229 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37231 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37232 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37236 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37237 .cindex "statistics"
37238 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37239 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37240 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37241 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
37242 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
37244 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37245 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37246 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37247 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37248 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37250 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37252 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37253 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37254 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37255 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37256 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37257 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37258 also produced per user.
37260 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37261 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37262 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37263 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37264 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37266 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37267 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37268 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37269 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37270 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37271 an entirely separate message.
37273 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37274 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37275 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37276 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37277 least one address that failed.
37279 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37280 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37281 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37282 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37283 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37284 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37285 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37287 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37288 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37289 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37291 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37292 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37293 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37295 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37298 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37299 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37300 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37301 .cindex "checking access"
37302 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37303 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37304 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37305 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37306 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37307 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37309 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37310 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37312 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37314 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37315 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37316 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37317 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37320 550 Relay not permitted
37322 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37323 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37324 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37325 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37328 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37329 -f himself@there.example
37331 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37332 mandatory arguments.
37334 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37335 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37336 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37340 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37341 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37342 .cindex "building DBM files"
37343 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37344 .cindex "lower casing"
37345 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37346 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37347 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37348 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37349 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37350 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37352 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37353 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37354 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37355 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37358 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37359 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37360 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37364 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37365 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37366 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37367 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37369 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37371 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37372 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37374 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37375 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37376 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37377 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37378 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37379 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37381 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37382 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37383 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37384 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37385 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37386 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37387 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37393 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37394 .cindex "retry" "times"
37395 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37396 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37397 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37398 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37399 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37400 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37401 output. For example:
37403 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37404 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37405 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37406 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37407 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37408 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37409 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37410 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37411 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37412 past final cutoff time
37414 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37415 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37416 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37417 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37418 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37419 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37422 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37423 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37424 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37425 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37426 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37427 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37431 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37432 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37433 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37434 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37435 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37436 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37437 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37440 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37442 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37445 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37447 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37449 &'misc'&: other hints data
37452 The &'misc'& database is used for
37455 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37457 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37458 &(smtp)& transport)
37460 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37466 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37467 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37468 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37469 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37470 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37472 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37474 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37476 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37477 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37479 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37480 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37481 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37482 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37483 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37484 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37485 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37486 and a textual description of the error.
37488 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37489 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37490 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37493 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37494 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37495 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37496 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37497 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37498 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37503 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37504 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37505 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37506 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37507 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37508 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37509 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37510 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37511 updated sufficiently often.
37513 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37514 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37515 the retry database:
37517 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37519 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37520 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37521 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37522 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37523 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37524 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37525 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37526 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37527 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37528 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37529 whenever it removes information from the database.
37531 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37532 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37533 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37534 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37535 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37537 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37538 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37539 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37540 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37541 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37542 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37543 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37546 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37547 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37552 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37553 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37554 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37555 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37556 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37557 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37558 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37561 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37562 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37563 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37564 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37565 by new data, for example:
37569 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37570 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37571 used as optional separators.
37576 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37577 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37578 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37579 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37580 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37581 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37582 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37583 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37584 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37585 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37586 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37587 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37588 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37592 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37595 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37598 .vitem &%-interval%&
37599 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37600 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37602 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37603 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37606 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37609 Suppress verification output.
37611 .vitem &%-retries%&
37612 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37613 the lock (default 10).
37615 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37616 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37617 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37618 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37621 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37622 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37623 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37624 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37627 Generate verbose output.
37630 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37631 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37632 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37633 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37634 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37635 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37636 more than 30 minutes old.
37638 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37639 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37640 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37641 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37642 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37643 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37645 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37646 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37647 suppresses all output except error messages.
37651 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37653 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37655 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37656 <&'some commands'&>
37659 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37660 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37663 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37664 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37666 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37667 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37674 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37675 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37676 .cindex "X-windows"
37677 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37678 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37679 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37680 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37681 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37682 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37683 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37684 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37688 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37689 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37690 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37691 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37692 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37693 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37694 parameters are for.
37696 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37697 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37698 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37700 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37702 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37703 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37704 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37705 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37706 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37708 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37709 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37711 Eximon*background: gray94
37713 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37714 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37715 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37716 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37717 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37718 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37719 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37722 Eximon*highlight: gray
37725 .cindex "admin user"
37726 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37727 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37729 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37730 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37731 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37732 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37733 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37735 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37736 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37737 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37738 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37739 different parts of the display.
37744 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37745 .cindex "stripchart"
37746 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37747 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37748 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37749 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37750 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37751 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37752 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37753 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37754 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37756 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37757 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37758 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37759 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37761 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37762 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37763 to a single partition.
37765 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37766 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37767 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37768 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37769 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37770 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37771 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37776 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37777 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37778 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37779 .cindex "window size"
37780 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37781 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37782 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37783 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37784 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37785 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37787 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37788 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37789 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37790 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37792 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37793 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37794 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37795 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37796 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37797 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37799 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37800 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37801 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37805 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37806 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37807 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37808 the main log is maintained.
37809 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37810 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37811 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37812 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37813 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37815 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37816 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37817 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37818 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37819 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37820 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37821 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37822 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37823 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37824 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37825 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37827 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37828 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37829 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37830 It cannot go further back up the log.
37832 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37833 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37834 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37835 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37836 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37837 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37839 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37840 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37841 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37842 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37843 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37844 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37846 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37847 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37848 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37849 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37850 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37851 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37852 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37853 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37854 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37859 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37860 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37861 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37862 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37863 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37864 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37865 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37866 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37867 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37868 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37870 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37871 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37872 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37873 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37874 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37875 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37876 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37878 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37879 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37880 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37881 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37882 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37883 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37884 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37886 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37887 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37888 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37889 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37891 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37892 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37893 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37894 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37895 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37896 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37897 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37900 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37901 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37903 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37904 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37905 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37906 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37907 display is updated.
37911 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37912 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37913 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37914 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37915 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37918 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37919 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37920 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37921 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37922 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37924 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37926 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37930 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37931 in a new text window.
37933 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37934 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37935 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37937 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37938 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37939 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37940 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37942 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37943 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37944 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37945 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37946 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37948 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37949 that the message be frozen.
37951 .cindex "thawing messages"
37952 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37953 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37954 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37955 that the message be thawed.
37957 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37958 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37959 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37960 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37962 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37963 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37966 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37967 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37968 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37969 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37970 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37971 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37972 which case no action is taken.
37974 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37975 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37976 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37977 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37978 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37979 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37980 case no action is taken.
37982 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37983 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37985 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37986 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37987 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37988 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37989 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37990 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37991 the address is qualified with that domain.
37994 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37995 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37996 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37997 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37998 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37999 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38000 if no output is generated.
38002 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38003 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38004 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38005 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38007 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38008 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38009 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38019 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38020 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38021 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38022 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38024 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38025 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38026 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38027 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38028 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38029 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38031 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38032 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38033 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38034 as soon as possible.
38037 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38038 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38039 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38040 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38041 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38042 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38045 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38046 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
38047 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
38048 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38049 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38050 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38052 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38053 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38054 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38055 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38058 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38059 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38060 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38061 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38062 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38063 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38064 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38065 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38066 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38070 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38071 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38072 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38073 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38074 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38075 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38076 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38078 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38081 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38082 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38083 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38084 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38085 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38090 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38092 .cindex "root privilege"
38093 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38094 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38095 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38096 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38097 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38098 is required for two things:
38101 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38102 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38105 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38106 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38110 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38111 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38112 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38113 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38114 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38115 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38116 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38117 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38119 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38120 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38121 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38123 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38124 uid and gid in the following cases:
38129 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38130 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38131 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38132 the calling process.
38133 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38134 option may not be used at all.
38135 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38136 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38137 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38142 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38143 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38146 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38147 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38148 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38149 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38150 testing address verification
38153 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38156 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38157 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38160 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38163 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38164 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38165 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38166 will be used during message reception.
38168 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38169 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38171 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38172 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38173 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38174 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38175 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38176 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38177 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38178 generating bounce and warning messages.
38180 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38181 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38182 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38183 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38185 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38186 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38192 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38193 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38194 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38195 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38196 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38197 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38198 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38199 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38200 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38201 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38205 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38206 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38207 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38208 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38210 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38211 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38212 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38213 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38214 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38216 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38217 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38218 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38221 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38222 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38223 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38225 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38226 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38227 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38228 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38229 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38230 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38231 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38232 address this problem at this time.
38234 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38235 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38236 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38237 be used in the most straightforward way.
38239 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38240 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38243 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38244 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38245 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38246 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38247 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38249 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38250 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38252 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38253 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38254 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38255 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38257 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38258 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38261 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38262 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38263 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38265 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38266 owned by the Exim user.
38268 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38269 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38270 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38275 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38276 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38277 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38278 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38280 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38281 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38286 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38287 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38288 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38292 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38293 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38294 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38295 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38296 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38297 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38298 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38301 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38302 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38303 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38304 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38305 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38307 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38308 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38309 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38310 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38311 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38312 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38313 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38315 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38316 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38317 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38319 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38320 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38322 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38323 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38324 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38326 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38327 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38328 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38330 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38331 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38332 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38333 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38339 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38340 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38341 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38342 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38343 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38344 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38345 are some issues to be aware of:
38348 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38350 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38352 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38353 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38354 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38355 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38356 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38357 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38360 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38361 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38362 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38364 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38365 expected to yield one result.
38371 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38372 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38373 .cindex "IP source routing"
38374 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38375 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38376 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38377 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38381 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38382 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38383 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38388 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38389 .cindex "trusted users"
38390 .cindex "admin user"
38391 .cindex "privileged user"
38392 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38393 .cindex "user" "admin"
38394 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38395 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38396 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38397 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38398 permit a remote host to be specified.
38401 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38402 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38403 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38404 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38405 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38406 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38408 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38409 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38410 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38411 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38412 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38414 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38415 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38416 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38417 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38418 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38422 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38423 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38424 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38425 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38426 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38427 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38429 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38430 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38431 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38432 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38433 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38434 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38437 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38438 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38439 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38440 This affects most of the checking options,
38441 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38444 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38445 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38446 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38447 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38448 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38449 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38453 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38454 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38455 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38456 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38457 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38462 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38463 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38464 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38465 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38470 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38471 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38472 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38473 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38474 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38478 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38479 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38480 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38484 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38485 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38486 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38487 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38488 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38489 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38490 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38492 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38493 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38498 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38499 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38500 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38501 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38505 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38506 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38507 enough to hold the result.
38508 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38513 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38516 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38517 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38518 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38519 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38520 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38521 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38522 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38523 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38524 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38525 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38526 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38527 themselves are recoverable.
38529 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38530 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38531 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38534 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38535 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38536 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38537 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38538 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38540 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38541 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38542 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38543 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38545 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38547 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38550 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38552 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38553 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38554 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38555 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38556 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38557 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38558 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38559 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38562 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38563 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38564 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38565 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38567 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38568 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38569 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38570 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38571 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38572 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38573 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38574 normally the Exim user.
38576 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38577 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38578 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38579 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38580 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38581 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38582 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38583 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38585 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38586 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38587 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38588 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38590 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38591 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38594 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38595 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38596 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38597 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38598 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38599 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38600 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38601 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38602 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38605 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38606 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38607 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38608 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38609 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38610 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38612 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38613 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38614 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38615 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38616 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38617 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38619 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38620 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38621 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38623 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38624 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38625 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38626 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38627 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38629 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38630 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38631 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38632 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38633 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38635 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38636 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38637 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38639 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38640 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38641 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38643 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38644 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38645 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38647 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38648 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38649 present if the number is greater than zero.
38651 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38652 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38653 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38655 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38656 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38657 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38659 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38660 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38663 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38664 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38665 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38668 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38669 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38670 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38671 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38673 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38674 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38675 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38677 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38678 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38679 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38680 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38681 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38682 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38684 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38685 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38686 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38687 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38688 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38690 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38691 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38692 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38693 generated messages.
38696 The message is from a local sender.
38698 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38699 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38701 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38702 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38703 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38704 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38706 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38707 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38708 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38711 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38712 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38715 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38716 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38717 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38719 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38720 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38721 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38723 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38724 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38725 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38727 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38728 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38729 rather than Unix-format.
38730 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38731 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38733 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38734 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38735 certificate was verified by the server.
38737 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38738 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38739 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38741 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38742 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38743 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38747 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38748 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38749 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38750 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38751 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38752 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38753 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38754 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38755 addresses are complete.
38757 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38758 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38759 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38760 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38761 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38762 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38764 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38765 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38766 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38768 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38769 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38770 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38771 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38775 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38776 darcy@austen.fict.example
38778 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38780 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38781 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38782 line is of the following form:
38784 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38785 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38787 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38788 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38789 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38790 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38791 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38792 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38793 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38794 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38797 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38798 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38799 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38800 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38801 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38805 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38806 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38807 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38808 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38809 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38810 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38811 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38812 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38813 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38814 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38817 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38818 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38819 typical set of headers:
38821 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38822 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38823 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38824 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38825 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38826 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38827 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38828 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38829 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38830 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38831 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38833 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38834 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38835 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38836 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38837 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38838 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38840 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38841 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38842 an ASCII newline character.
38843 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38844 can have an alternate format.
38845 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38846 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38847 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38848 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38849 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38850 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38852 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38853 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38855 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38856 "DKIM and SPF Support"
38859 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
38861 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38862 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38863 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38864 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
38867 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
38868 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
38869 any original DKIM signature.
38872 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38873 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38875 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38877 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38878 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38879 (including transport filters)
38880 except cutthrough delivery.
38882 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38883 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38884 different signature contexts.
38887 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38888 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38889 Exim's standard controls.
38892 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38893 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
38895 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
38896 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
38897 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38898 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38900 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38901 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38902 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38903 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38907 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38908 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38909 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38910 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38914 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38915 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38918 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
38919 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38921 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38923 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38924 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38927 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
38928 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
38929 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
38930 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
38931 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
38934 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38935 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38937 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38938 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38939 After expansion, this can be a list.
38940 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38941 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38942 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
38943 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38945 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38946 This sets the key selector string.
38947 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38948 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38949 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38950 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38951 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
38952 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38954 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38955 This sets the private key to use.
38956 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38957 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38958 The result can either
38960 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
38963 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
38964 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
38967 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38970 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38971 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38976 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
38978 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
38979 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
38981 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
38982 for the DNS TXT record.
38983 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
38987 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
38988 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
38991 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38993 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38994 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38997 Support for EC keys is being developed under
38998 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
38999 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39000 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39001 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39002 for some transition period.
39003 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39006 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39008 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39009 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39012 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39014 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39015 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39019 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39020 Can be set alternatively to &"sha1"& to use an alternate hash
39024 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39026 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39030 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39031 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39032 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39033 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39034 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39035 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39037 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39038 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39039 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39040 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39041 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39043 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39044 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39045 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39046 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39047 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39050 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39051 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39052 list of header names.
39053 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39054 in the message signature.
39055 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39056 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39057 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39058 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39060 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39061 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39062 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39064 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39065 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39067 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39068 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39069 name will be appended.
39072 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39073 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39075 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
39076 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
39077 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39078 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39079 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39080 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39081 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39083 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
39084 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39085 runtime of the ACL.
39088 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39089 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39090 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39093 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39094 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39095 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39096 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39098 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39099 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39100 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39101 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39102 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39103 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39106 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39108 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39109 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39110 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39112 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39114 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39115 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39116 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39118 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39121 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39122 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39124 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39125 for each matching signature.
39128 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39129 available (from most to least important):
39133 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39134 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39135 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39136 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39138 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39139 Within the DKIM ACL,
39140 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39142 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39143 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39145 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39146 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39148 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39149 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39151 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39154 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39155 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39156 hash-method or key-size:
39158 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39159 condition = ${if eq {$len_3:$dkim_algo}{rsa}}
39160 condition = ${if or {eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39161 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}} }
39162 logwrite = NOTE: forcing dkim verify fail (was pass)
39163 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39164 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39167 After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39168 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39170 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39171 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39172 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39174 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39175 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39177 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39178 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39180 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39181 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39182 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39184 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39185 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39186 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39187 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39190 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39192 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39193 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39194 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39195 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39197 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39198 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39199 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39200 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39202 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39203 The key record selector string.
39205 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39206 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39208 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39209 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39210 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39215 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39217 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39219 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39220 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39223 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39224 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39227 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39228 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39230 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39231 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39233 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39234 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39235 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39236 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39237 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39238 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39240 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39241 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39242 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39243 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39245 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39246 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39247 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39249 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39250 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39251 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39252 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39253 integer size comparisons against this value.
39255 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39258 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39259 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39261 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39262 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39264 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39265 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39267 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39268 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39271 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39272 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39275 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39276 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39278 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39279 Number of bits in the key.
39282 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39284 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39285 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39288 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39289 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39290 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39295 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39298 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39299 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39300 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39301 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39302 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39305 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39306 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39307 sender_domains = gmail.com
39308 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39312 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39313 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39315 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39316 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39317 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39318 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39321 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39322 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39323 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39324 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39327 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39328 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39329 for more information of what they mean.
39336 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39337 .cindex SPF verification
39339 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39340 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39341 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39343 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39344 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39346 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39347 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39348 &url(http://www.libspf2.org/).
39349 There is no Exim involvement on the trasmission of messages; publishing certain
39350 DNS records is all that is required.
39352 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39354 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39355 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39356 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39360 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39361 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
39362 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39363 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39364 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39368 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39371 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39372 domain in the envelope-from address.
39374 .vitem &%softfail%&
39375 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39379 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39382 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39383 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39384 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39386 .vitem &%permerror%&
39387 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39388 You may deny messages when this occurs.
39390 .vitem &%temperror%&
39391 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39392 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39395 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39396 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39397 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39398 short-circuit fashion.
39403 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39404 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39405 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39406 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39407 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39408 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39409 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39410 ip=$sender_host_address
39413 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39416 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
39418 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39419 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39420 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39421 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39422 it for logging purposes.
39424 .vitem &$spf_received$&
39425 .vindex &$spf_received$&
39426 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39427 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39428 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39429 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39431 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39432 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39434 .vitem &$spf_result$&
39435 .vindex &$spf_result$&
39436 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39437 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39440 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
39441 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
39442 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
39443 and required in order to obtain a result.
39445 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39446 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39447 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39448 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39452 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39453 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39454 .cindex SPF "best guess"
39455 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39456 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39457 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39459 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39460 for a description of what it means.
39462 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39463 of the spf one. For example:
39466 deny spf_guess = fail
39467 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39470 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39471 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39472 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39475 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39476 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39478 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39479 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39480 &%spf_guess%& option.
39481 For example, the following:
39484 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39487 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39490 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39492 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39493 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39496 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39499 The lookup will return the same result strings as they can appear in
39500 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39501 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39504 . wen-for SPF section
39508 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39511 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39513 .cindex "proxy support"
39514 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
39516 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39517 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39520 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39521 .cindex proxy inbound
39522 .cindex proxy "server side"
39523 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39524 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39526 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39527 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39528 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39531 It was built on specifications from:
39532 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
39533 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
39534 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
39536 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39537 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39538 to distribute load.
39539 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39540 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39541 There is no logging if a host passes or
39542 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39543 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39545 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39546 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39547 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39548 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39549 automatically determines which version is in use.
39551 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39552 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39553 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39554 Exim and the proxy server.
39556 The following expansion variables are usable
39557 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39560 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39561 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39562 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39563 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39564 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39566 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39567 there was a protocol error.
39569 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39570 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39571 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39572 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39573 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39574 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39575 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39576 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39577 A possible solution is:
39579 # Set max number of connections per host
39581 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39582 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39584 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39585 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39590 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39591 .cindex proxy outbound
39592 .cindex proxy "client side"
39593 .cindex proxy SOCKS
39594 .cindex SOCKS proxy
39595 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39596 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39597 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39600 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39601 on an smtp transport.
39602 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39603 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39604 Each proxy specifier is a list
39605 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
39606 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39608 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39609 The list of options is in the following table:
39611 &'auth '& authentication method
39612 &'name '& authentication username
39613 &'pass '& authentication password
39615 &'tmo '& connection timeout
39617 &'weight '& selection bias
39620 More details on each of these options follows:
39623 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
39624 .cindex proxy authentication
39625 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39626 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39627 for access to the proxy.
39628 Default is &"none"&.
39630 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39633 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39636 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39639 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39642 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39643 higher values being tried first.
39644 The default priority is 1.
39646 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39647 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39648 weighted by this value.
39649 The default value for selection bias is 1.
39652 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39653 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39654 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39656 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
39657 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39658 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39659 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39664 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39665 "Internationalisation""
39666 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
39669 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39671 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39672 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39673 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39675 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39676 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39677 requirement, upon libidn2.
39679 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39680 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39681 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39682 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39683 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39684 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39686 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39687 international handling for the message is enabled and
39688 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39690 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39691 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39692 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39693 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39695 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39696 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39697 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39698 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39700 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39701 components expanded to a-label form,
39702 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39705 .cindex log protocol
39706 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39707 .cindex i18n logging
39708 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39709 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39711 The following expansion operators can be used:
39713 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39714 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39715 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39716 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39719 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
39720 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
39724 may use the following modifier:
39726 control = utf8_downconvert
39727 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39729 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39730 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39731 Message Submission Agent context.
39732 If a value is appended it may be:
39734 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39735 &`0 `& no downconversion
39736 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39739 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39740 is initially set to -1.
39743 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39744 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39745 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39747 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39748 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39749 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39751 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39752 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39756 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39757 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39758 the following expansion operator can be used:
39760 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39763 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39764 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39765 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39767 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39768 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
39769 (which has to be a single character)
39770 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39771 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39773 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39774 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39776 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39777 by many other IMAP servers.
39781 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39782 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39783 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39786 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39787 must be representable in UTF-16.
39790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39793 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39797 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39798 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39799 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39800 processing actions.
39802 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39803 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39804 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39806 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39807 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39808 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39810 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39811 An example might look like:
39812 .cindex logging custom
39814 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39815 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39816 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39817 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39818 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39819 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39820 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39821 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39822 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39826 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39827 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39828 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39830 The current list of events is:
39832 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
39833 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39834 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39835 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39836 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39837 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39838 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39839 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39840 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39841 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39842 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39843 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39845 New event types may be added in future.
39847 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39848 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39849 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39851 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39852 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39853 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39855 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
39856 should define the event action.
39858 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39859 with the event type:
39861 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
39862 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39863 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39864 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39865 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39866 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39867 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39870 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39872 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39873 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39874 the course of its processing:
39876 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39879 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39880 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39882 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39883 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39885 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39886 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39887 following will be forced:
39889 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39890 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39891 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39893 All other message types ignore the result string, and
39894 no other use is made of it.
39896 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39897 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39900 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39901 chain element received on the connection.
39902 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39908 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39909 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39910 .cindex "adding drivers"
39911 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39912 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39913 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39914 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39917 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39918 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39920 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39922 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39924 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39925 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39926 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39928 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39930 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39933 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39934 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39936 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39937 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39938 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39939 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39940 simple form that most lookups have.
39942 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39943 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39944 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39946 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39949 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39950 as for other drivers and lookups.
39953 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39954 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39955 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39956 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39957 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39959 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39960 the interface that is expected.
39965 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39968 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39969 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39970 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39971 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39973 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39978 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39979 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39983 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39984 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39985 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39988 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39989 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////